Documentation ¶
Index ¶
- type AacCodingMode
- type AacInputType
- type AacProfile
- type AacRateControlMode
- type AacRawFormat
- type AacSettings
- type AacSpec
- type AacVbrQuality
- type Ac3BitstreamMode
- type Ac3CodingMode
- type Ac3DrcProfile
- type Ac3LfeFilter
- type Ac3MetadataControl
- type Ac3Settings
- type AcceptHeader
- type AfdSignaling
- type AncillarySourceSettings
- type ArchiveCdnSettings
- type ArchiveContainerSettings
- type ArchiveGroupSettings
- type ArchiveOutputSettings
- type ArchiveS3Settings
- type AribDestinationSettings
- type AribSourceSettings
- type AudioChannelMapping
- type AudioCodecSettings
- type AudioDescription
- type AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl
- type AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl
- type AudioLanguageSelection
- type AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy
- type AudioNormalizationAlgorithm
- type AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl
- type AudioNormalizationSettings
- type AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType
- type AudioOnlyHlsSettings
- type AudioOnlyHlsTrackType
- type AudioPidSelection
- type AudioSelector
- type AudioSelectorSettings
- type AudioSilenceFailoverSettings
- type AudioTrack
- type AudioTrackSelection
- type AudioType
- type AuthenticationScheme
- type AutomaticInputFailoverSettings
- type AvailBlanking
- type AvailBlankingState
- type AvailConfiguration
- type AvailSettings
- type BadGatewayException
- type BadRequestException
- type BatchFailedResultModel
- type BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest
- type BatchScheduleActionCreateResult
- type BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest
- type BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult
- type BatchSuccessfulResultModel
- type BlackoutSlate
- type BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout
- type BlackoutSlateState
- type BurnInAlignment
- type BurnInBackgroundColor
- type BurnInDestinationSettings
- type BurnInFontColor
- type BurnInOutlineColor
- type BurnInShadowColor
- type BurnInTeletextGridControl
- type CaptionDescription
- type CaptionDestinationSettings
- type CaptionLanguageMapping
- type CaptionRectangle
- type CaptionSelector
- type CaptionSelectorSettings
- type CdiInputResolution
- type CdiInputSpecification
- type Channel
- type ChannelClass
- type ChannelEgressEndpoint
- type ChannelState
- type ChannelSummary
- type ColorSpacePassthroughSettings
- type ConflictException
- type ContentType
- type DeviceSettingsSyncState
- type DeviceUpdateStatus
- type DvbNitSettings
- type DvbSdtOutputSdt
- type DvbSdtSettings
- type DvbSubDestinationAlignment
- type DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor
- type DvbSubDestinationFontColor
- type DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor
- type DvbSubDestinationSettings
- type DvbSubDestinationShadowColor
- type DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl
- type DvbSubSourceSettings
- type DvbTdtSettings
- type Eac3AttenuationControl
- type Eac3BitstreamMode
- type Eac3CodingMode
- type Eac3DcFilter
- type Eac3DrcLine
- type Eac3DrcRf
- type Eac3LfeControl
- type Eac3LfeFilter
- type Eac3MetadataControl
- type Eac3PassthroughControl
- type Eac3PhaseControl
- type Eac3Settings
- type Eac3StereoDownmix
- type Eac3SurroundExMode
- type Eac3SurroundMode
- type EbuTtDDestinationSettings
- type EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl
- type EbuTtDFillLineGapControl
- type EmbeddedConvert608To708
- type EmbeddedDestinationSettings
- type EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings
- type EmbeddedScte20Detection
- type EmbeddedSourceSettings
- type EncoderSettings
- type FailoverCondition
- type FailoverConditionSettings
- type FeatureActivations
- type FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions
- type FecOutputIncludeFec
- type FecOutputSettings
- type FixedAfd
- type FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings
- type Fmp4HlsSettings
- type Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior
- type Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior
- type FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings
- type FollowPoint
- type ForbiddenException
- type FrameCaptureCdnSettings
- type FrameCaptureGroupSettings
- type FrameCaptureHlsSettings
- type FrameCaptureIntervalUnit
- type FrameCaptureOutputSettings
- type FrameCaptureS3Settings
- type FrameCaptureSettings
- type GatewayTimeoutException
- type GlobalConfiguration
- type GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction
- type GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs
- type GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode
- type GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource
- type H264AdaptiveQuantization
- type H264ColorMetadata
- type H264ColorSpaceSettings
- type H264EntropyEncoding
- type H264FilterSettings
- type H264FlickerAq
- type H264ForceFieldPictures
- type H264FramerateControl
- type H264GopBReference
- type H264GopSizeUnits
- type H264Level
- type H264LookAheadRateControl
- type H264ParControl
- type H264Profile
- type H264QualityLevel
- type H264RateControlMode
- type H264ScanType
- type H264SceneChangeDetect
- type H264Settings
- type H264SpatialAq
- type H264SubGopLength
- type H264Syntax
- type H264TemporalAq
- type H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior
- type H265AdaptiveQuantization
- type H265AlternativeTransferFunction
- type H265ColorMetadata
- type H265ColorSpaceSettings
- type H265FilterSettings
- type H265FlickerAq
- type H265GopSizeUnits
- type H265Level
- type H265LookAheadRateControl
- type H265Profile
- type H265RateControlMode
- type H265ScanType
- type H265SceneChangeDetect
- type H265Settings
- type H265Tier
- type H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior
- type Hdr10Settings
- type HlsAdMarkers
- type HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode
- type HlsAkamaiSettings
- type HlsBasicPutSettings
- type HlsCaptionLanguageSetting
- type HlsCdnSettings
- type HlsClientCache
- type HlsCodecSpecification
- type HlsDirectoryStructure
- type HlsDiscontinuityTags
- type HlsEncryptionType
- type HlsGroupSettings
- type HlsH265PackagingType
- type HlsId3SegmentTaggingScheduleActionSettings
- type HlsId3SegmentTaggingState
- type HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior
- type HlsInputSettings
- type HlsIvInManifest
- type HlsIvSource
- type HlsManifestCompression
- type HlsManifestDurationFormat
- type HlsMediaStoreSettings
- type HlsMediaStoreStorageClass
- type HlsMode
- type HlsOutputSelection
- type HlsOutputSettings
- type HlsProgramDateTime
- type HlsRedundantManifest
- type HlsS3Settings
- type HlsSegmentationMode
- type HlsSettings
- type HlsStreamInfResolution
- type HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame
- type HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings
- type HlsTsFileMode
- type HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode
- type HlsWebdavSettings
- type HtmlMotionGraphicsSettings
- type IFrameOnlyPlaylistType
- type ImmediateModeScheduleActionStartSettings
- type Input
- type InputAttachment
- type InputChannelLevel
- type InputClass
- type InputClippingSettings
- type InputCodec
- type InputDeblockFilter
- type InputDenoiseFilter
- type InputDestination
- type InputDestinationRequest
- type InputDestinationVpc
- type InputDeviceActiveInput
- type InputDeviceConfigurableSettings
- type InputDeviceConfiguredInput
- type InputDeviceConnectionState
- type InputDeviceHdSettings
- type InputDeviceIpScheme
- type InputDeviceNetworkSettings
- type InputDeviceRequest
- type InputDeviceScanType
- type InputDeviceSettings
- type InputDeviceState
- type InputDeviceSummary
- type InputDeviceTransferType
- type InputDeviceType
- type InputDeviceUhdSettings
- type InputFilter
- type InputLocation
- type InputLossActionForHlsOut
- type InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut
- type InputLossActionForRtmpOut
- type InputLossActionForUdpOut
- type InputLossBehavior
- type InputLossFailoverSettings
- type InputLossImageType
- type InputMaximumBitrate
- type InputPreference
- type InputPrepareScheduleActionSettings
- type InputResolution
- type InputSecurityGroup
- type InputSecurityGroupState
- type InputSettings
- type InputSource
- type InputSourceEndBehavior
- type InputSourceRequest
- type InputSourceType
- type InputSpecification
- type InputState
- type InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings
- type InputTimecodeSource
- type InputType
- type InputVpcRequest
- type InputWhitelistRule
- type InputWhitelistRuleCidr
- type InternalServerErrorException
- type KeyProviderSettings
- type LastFrameClippingBehavior
- type LogLevel
- type M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior
- type M2tsArib
- type M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl
- type M2tsAudioBufferModel
- type M2tsAudioInterval
- type M2tsAudioStreamType
- type M2tsBufferModel
- type M2tsCcDescriptor
- type M2tsEbifControl
- type M2tsEbpPlacement
- type M2tsEsRateInPes
- type M2tsKlv
- type M2tsNielsenId3Behavior
- type M2tsPcrControl
- type M2tsRateMode
- type M2tsScte35Control
- type M2tsSegmentationMarkers
- type M2tsSegmentationStyle
- type M2tsSettings
- type M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior
- type M3u8NielsenId3Behavior
- type M3u8PcrControl
- type M3u8Scte35Behavior
- type M3u8Settings
- type M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior
- type MediaConnectFlow
- type MediaConnectFlowRequest
- type MediaPackageGroupSettings
- type MediaPackageOutputDestinationSettings
- type MediaPackageOutputSettings
- type MotionGraphicsActivateScheduleActionSettings
- type MotionGraphicsConfiguration
- type MotionGraphicsDeactivateScheduleActionSettings
- type MotionGraphicsInsertion
- type MotionGraphicsSettings
- type Mp2CodingMode
- type Mp2Settings
- type Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization
- type Mpeg2ColorMetadata
- type Mpeg2ColorSpace
- type Mpeg2DisplayRatio
- type Mpeg2FilterSettings
- type Mpeg2GopSizeUnits
- type Mpeg2ScanType
- type Mpeg2Settings
- type Mpeg2SubGopLength
- type Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior
- type MsSmoothGroupSettings
- type MsSmoothH265PackagingType
- type MsSmoothOutputSettings
- type Multiplex
- type MultiplexGroupSettings
- type MultiplexMediaConnectOutputDestinationSettings
- type MultiplexOutputDestination
- type MultiplexOutputSettings
- type MultiplexProgram
- type MultiplexProgramChannelDestinationSettings
- type MultiplexProgramPacketIdentifiersMap
- type MultiplexProgramPipelineDetail
- type MultiplexProgramServiceDescriptor
- type MultiplexProgramSettings
- type MultiplexProgramSummary
- type MultiplexSettings
- type MultiplexSettingsSummary
- type MultiplexState
- type MultiplexStatmuxVideoSettings
- type MultiplexSummary
- type MultiplexVideoSettings
- type NetworkInputServerValidation
- type NetworkInputSettings
- type NielsenConfiguration
- type NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState
- type NotFoundException
- type Offering
- type OfferingDurationUnits
- type OfferingType
- type Output
- type OutputDestination
- type OutputDestinationSettings
- type OutputGroup
- type OutputGroupSettings
- type OutputLocationRef
- type OutputSettings
- type PassThroughSettings
- type PauseStateScheduleActionSettings
- type PipelineDetail
- type PipelineId
- type PipelinePauseStateSettings
- type PreferredChannelPipeline
- type RawSettings
- type Rec601Settings
- type Rec709Settings
- type RemixSettings
- type Reservation
- type ReservationCodec
- type ReservationMaximumBitrate
- type ReservationMaximumFramerate
- type ReservationResolution
- type ReservationResourceSpecification
- type ReservationResourceType
- type ReservationSpecialFeature
- type ReservationState
- type ReservationVideoQuality
- type RtmpAdMarkers
- type RtmpCacheFullBehavior
- type RtmpCaptionData
- type RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings
- type RtmpGroupSettings
- type RtmpOutputCertificateMode
- type RtmpOutputSettings
- type S3CannedAcl
- type ScheduleAction
- type ScheduleActionSettings
- type ScheduleActionStartSettings
- type Scte20Convert608To708
- type Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings
- type Scte20SourceSettings
- type Scte27DestinationSettings
- type Scte27SourceSettings
- type Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior
- type Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior
- type Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag
- type Scte35DeliveryRestrictions
- type Scte35Descriptor
- type Scte35DescriptorSettings
- type Scte35DeviceRestrictions
- type Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag
- type Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings
- type Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator
- type Scte35SegmentationDescriptor
- type Scte35SpliceInsert
- type Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior
- type Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings
- type Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior
- type Scte35TimeSignalApos
- type Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings
- type Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag
- type SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl
- type SmoothGroupCertificateMode
- type SmoothGroupEventIdMode
- type SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior
- type SmoothGroupSegmentationMode
- type SmoothGroupSparseTrackType
- type SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior
- type SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode
- type Smpte2038DataPreference
- type SmpteTtDestinationSettings
- type StandardHlsSettings
- type StartTimecode
- type StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings
- type StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings
- type StaticKeySettings
- type StopTimecode
- type TeletextDestinationSettings
- type TeletextSourceSettings
- type TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening
- type TemporalFilterSettings
- type TemporalFilterStrength
- type TimecodeConfig
- type TimecodeConfigSource
- type TooManyRequestsException
- type TransferringInputDeviceSummary
- type TtmlDestinationSettings
- type TtmlDestinationStyleControl
- type UdpContainerSettings
- type UdpGroupSettings
- type UdpOutputSettings
- type UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame
- type UnprocessableEntityException
- type ValidationError
- type VideoBlackFailoverSettings
- type VideoCodecSettings
- type VideoDescription
- type VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd
- type VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior
- type VideoSelector
- type VideoSelectorColorSpace
- type VideoSelectorColorSpaceSettings
- type VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage
- type VideoSelectorPid
- type VideoSelectorProgramId
- type VideoSelectorSettings
- type VpcOutputSettings
- type VpcOutputSettingsDescription
- type WavCodingMode
- type WavSettings
- type WebvttDestinationSettings
Constants ¶
This section is empty.
Variables ¶
This section is empty.
Functions ¶
This section is empty.
Types ¶
type AacCodingMode ¶
type AacCodingMode string
const ( AacCodingModeAdReceiverMix AacCodingMode = "AD_RECEIVER_MIX" AacCodingModeCodingMode10 AacCodingMode = "CODING_MODE_1_0" AacCodingModeCodingMode11 AacCodingMode = "CODING_MODE_1_1" AacCodingModeCodingMode20 AacCodingMode = "CODING_MODE_2_0" AacCodingModeCodingMode51 AacCodingMode = "CODING_MODE_5_1" )
Enum values for AacCodingMode
func (AacCodingMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AacCodingMode) Values() []AacCodingMode
Values returns all known values for AacCodingMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AacInputType ¶
type AacInputType string
const ( AacInputTypeBroadcasterMixedAd AacInputType = "BROADCASTER_MIXED_AD" AacInputTypeNormal AacInputType = "NORMAL" )
Enum values for AacInputType
func (AacInputType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AacInputType) Values() []AacInputType
Values returns all known values for AacInputType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AacProfile ¶
type AacProfile string
const ( AacProfileHev1 AacProfile = "HEV1" AacProfileHev2 AacProfile = "HEV2" AacProfileLc AacProfile = "LC" )
Enum values for AacProfile
func (AacProfile) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AacProfile) Values() []AacProfile
Values returns all known values for AacProfile. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AacRateControlMode ¶
type AacRateControlMode string
const ( AacRateControlModeCbr AacRateControlMode = "CBR" AacRateControlModeVbr AacRateControlMode = "VBR" )
Enum values for AacRateControlMode
func (AacRateControlMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AacRateControlMode) Values() []AacRateControlMode
Values returns all known values for AacRateControlMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AacRawFormat ¶
type AacRawFormat string
const ( AacRawFormatLatmLoas AacRawFormat = "LATM_LOAS" AacRawFormatNone AacRawFormat = "NONE" )
Enum values for AacRawFormat
func (AacRawFormat) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AacRawFormat) Values() []AacRawFormat
Values returns all known values for AacRawFormat. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AacSettings ¶
type AacSettings struct { // Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid values depend on rate control mode and // profile. Bitrate float64 // Mono, Stereo, or 5.1 channel layout. Valid values depend on rate control mode // and profile. The adReceiverMix setting receives a stereo description plus // control track and emits a mono AAC encode of the description track, with control // data emitted in the PES header as per ETSI TS 101 154 Annex E. CodingMode AacCodingMode // Set to "broadcasterMixedAd" when input contains pre-mixed main audio + AD // (narration) as a stereo pair. The Audio Type field (audioType) will be set to 3, // which signals to downstream systems that this stream contains "broadcaster mixed // AD". Note that the input received by the encoder must contain pre-mixed audio; // the encoder does not perform the mixing. The values in audioTypeControl and // audioType (in AudioDescription) are ignored when set to broadcasterMixedAd. // Leave set to "normal" when input does not contain pre-mixed audio + AD. InputType AacInputType // AAC Profile. Profile AacProfile // Rate Control Mode. RateControlMode AacRateControlMode // Sets LATM / LOAS AAC output for raw containers. RawFormat AacRawFormat // Sample rate in Hz. Valid values depend on rate control mode and profile. SampleRate float64 // Use MPEG-2 AAC audio instead of MPEG-4 AAC audio for raw or MPEG-2 Transport // Stream containers. Spec AacSpec // VBR Quality Level - Only used if rateControlMode is VBR. VbrQuality AacVbrQuality }
Aac Settings
type AacVbrQuality ¶
type AacVbrQuality string
const ( AacVbrQualityHigh AacVbrQuality = "HIGH" AacVbrQualityLow AacVbrQuality = "LOW" AacVbrQualityMediumHigh AacVbrQuality = "MEDIUM_HIGH" AacVbrQualityMediumLow AacVbrQuality = "MEDIUM_LOW" )
Enum values for AacVbrQuality
func (AacVbrQuality) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AacVbrQuality) Values() []AacVbrQuality
Values returns all known values for AacVbrQuality. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Ac3BitstreamMode ¶
type Ac3BitstreamMode string
const ( Ac3BitstreamModeCommentary Ac3BitstreamMode = "COMMENTARY" Ac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain Ac3BitstreamMode = "COMPLETE_MAIN" Ac3BitstreamModeDialogue Ac3BitstreamMode = "DIALOGUE" Ac3BitstreamModeEmergency Ac3BitstreamMode = "EMERGENCY" Ac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired Ac3BitstreamMode = "HEARING_IMPAIRED" Ac3BitstreamModeMusicAndEffects Ac3BitstreamMode = "MUSIC_AND_EFFECTS" Ac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired Ac3BitstreamMode = "VISUALLY_IMPAIRED" Ac3BitstreamModeVoiceOver Ac3BitstreamMode = "VOICE_OVER" )
Enum values for Ac3BitstreamMode
func (Ac3BitstreamMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Ac3BitstreamMode) Values() []Ac3BitstreamMode
Values returns all known values for Ac3BitstreamMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Ac3CodingMode ¶
type Ac3CodingMode string
const ( Ac3CodingModeCodingMode10 Ac3CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_1_0" Ac3CodingModeCodingMode11 Ac3CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_1_1" Ac3CodingModeCodingMode20 Ac3CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_2_0" Ac3CodingModeCodingMode32Lfe Ac3CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_3_2_LFE" )
Enum values for Ac3CodingMode
func (Ac3CodingMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Ac3CodingMode) Values() []Ac3CodingMode
Values returns all known values for Ac3CodingMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Ac3DrcProfile ¶
type Ac3DrcProfile string
const ( Ac3DrcProfileFilmStandard Ac3DrcProfile = "FILM_STANDARD" Ac3DrcProfileNone Ac3DrcProfile = "NONE" )
Enum values for Ac3DrcProfile
func (Ac3DrcProfile) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Ac3DrcProfile) Values() []Ac3DrcProfile
Values returns all known values for Ac3DrcProfile. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Ac3LfeFilter ¶
type Ac3LfeFilter string
const ( Ac3LfeFilterDisabled Ac3LfeFilter = "DISABLED" Ac3LfeFilterEnabled Ac3LfeFilter = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for Ac3LfeFilter
func (Ac3LfeFilter) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Ac3LfeFilter) Values() []Ac3LfeFilter
Values returns all known values for Ac3LfeFilter. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Ac3MetadataControl ¶
type Ac3MetadataControl string
const ( Ac3MetadataControlFollowInput Ac3MetadataControl = "FOLLOW_INPUT" Ac3MetadataControlUseConfigured Ac3MetadataControl = "USE_CONFIGURED" )
Enum values for Ac3MetadataControl
func (Ac3MetadataControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Ac3MetadataControl) Values() []Ac3MetadataControl
Values returns all known values for Ac3MetadataControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Ac3Settings ¶
type Ac3Settings struct { // Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid bitrates depend on the coding mode. Bitrate float64 // Specifies the bitstream mode (bsmod) for the emitted AC-3 stream. See ATSC // A/52-2012 for background on these values. BitstreamMode Ac3BitstreamMode // Dolby Digital coding mode. Determines number of channels. CodingMode Ac3CodingMode // Sets the dialnorm for the output. If excluded and input audio is Dolby Digital, // dialnorm will be passed through. Dialnorm int32 // If set to filmStandard, adds dynamic range compression signaling to the output // bitstream as defined in the Dolby Digital specification. DrcProfile Ac3DrcProfile // When set to enabled, applies a 120Hz lowpass filter to the LFE channel prior to // encoding. Only valid in codingMode32Lfe mode. LfeFilter Ac3LfeFilter // When set to "followInput", encoder metadata will be sourced from the DD, DD+, or // DolbyE decoder that supplied this audio data. If audio was not supplied from one // of these streams, then the static metadata settings will be used. MetadataControl Ac3MetadataControl }
Ac3 Settings
type AcceptHeader ¶
type AcceptHeader string
const (
AcceptHeaderImageJpeg AcceptHeader = "image/jpeg"
)
Enum values for AcceptHeader
func (AcceptHeader) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AcceptHeader) Values() []AcceptHeader
Values returns all known values for AcceptHeader. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AfdSignaling ¶
type AfdSignaling string
const ( AfdSignalingAuto AfdSignaling = "AUTO" AfdSignalingFixed AfdSignaling = "FIXED" AfdSignalingNone AfdSignaling = "NONE" )
Enum values for AfdSignaling
func (AfdSignaling) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AfdSignaling) Values() []AfdSignaling
Values returns all known values for AfdSignaling. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AncillarySourceSettings ¶ added in v0.29.0
type AncillarySourceSettings struct { // Specifies the number (1 to 4) of the captions channel you want to extract from // the ancillary captions. If you plan to convert the ancillary captions to another // format, complete this field. If you plan to choose Embedded as the captions // destination in the output (to pass through all the channels in the ancillary // captions), leave this field blank because MediaLive ignores the field. SourceAncillaryChannelNumber int32 }
Ancillary Source Settings
type ArchiveCdnSettings ¶ added in v1.2.0
type ArchiveCdnSettings struct { // Archive S3 Settings ArchiveS3Settings *ArchiveS3Settings }
Archive Cdn Settings
type ArchiveContainerSettings ¶
type ArchiveContainerSettings struct { // M2ts Settings M2tsSettings *M2tsSettings // Raw Settings RawSettings *RawSettings }
Archive Container Settings
type ArchiveGroupSettings ¶
type ArchiveGroupSettings struct { // A directory and base filename where archive files should be written. // // This member is required. Destination *OutputLocationRef // Parameters that control interactions with the CDN. ArchiveCdnSettings *ArchiveCdnSettings // Number of seconds to write to archive file before closing and starting a new // one. RolloverInterval int32 }
Archive Group Settings
type ArchiveOutputSettings ¶
type ArchiveOutputSettings struct { // Settings specific to the container type of the file. // // This member is required. ContainerSettings *ArchiveContainerSettings // Output file extension. If excluded, this will be auto-selected from the // container type. Extension *string // String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Required for // multiple outputs of the same type. NameModifier *string }
Archive Output Settings
type ArchiveS3Settings ¶ added in v1.2.0
type ArchiveS3Settings struct { // Specify the canned ACL to apply to each S3 request. Defaults to none. CannedAcl S3CannedAcl }
Archive S3 Settings
type AudioChannelMapping ¶
type AudioChannelMapping struct { // Indices and gain values for each input channel that should be remixed into this // output channel. // // This member is required. InputChannelLevels []InputChannelLevel // The index of the output channel being produced. // // This member is required. OutputChannel int32 }
Audio Channel Mapping
type AudioCodecSettings ¶
type AudioCodecSettings struct { // Aac Settings AacSettings *AacSettings // Ac3 Settings Ac3Settings *Ac3Settings // Eac3 Settings Eac3Settings *Eac3Settings // Mp2 Settings Mp2Settings *Mp2Settings // Pass Through Settings PassThroughSettings *PassThroughSettings // Wav Settings WavSettings *WavSettings }
Audio Codec Settings
type AudioDescription ¶
type AudioDescription struct { // The name of the AudioSelector used as the source for this AudioDescription. // // This member is required. AudioSelectorName *string // The name of this AudioDescription. Outputs will use this name to uniquely // identify this AudioDescription. Description names should be unique within this // Live Event. // // This member is required. Name *string // Advanced audio normalization settings. AudioNormalizationSettings *AudioNormalizationSettings // Applies only if audioTypeControl is useConfigured. The values for audioType are // defined in ISO-IEC 13818-1. AudioType AudioType // Determines how audio type is determined. followInput: If the input contains an // ISO 639 audioType, then that value is passed through to the output. If the input // contains no ISO 639 audioType, the value in Audio Type is included in the // output. useConfigured: The value in Audio Type is included in the output. Note // that this field and audioType are both ignored if inputType is // broadcasterMixedAd. AudioTypeControl AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl // Audio codec settings. CodecSettings *AudioCodecSettings // RFC 5646 language code representing the language of the audio output track. Only // used if languageControlMode is useConfigured, or there is no ISO 639 language // code specified in the input. LanguageCode *string // Choosing followInput will cause the ISO 639 language code of the output to // follow the ISO 639 language code of the input. The languageCode will be used // when useConfigured is set, or when followInput is selected but there is no ISO // 639 language code specified by the input. LanguageCodeControl AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl // Settings that control how input audio channels are remixed into the output audio // channels. RemixSettings *RemixSettings // Used for MS Smooth and Apple HLS outputs. Indicates the name displayed by the // player (eg. English, or Director Commentary). StreamName *string }
Audio Description
type AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl ¶
type AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl string
const ( AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlFollowInput AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl = "FOLLOW_INPUT" AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlUseConfigured AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl = "USE_CONFIGURED" )
Enum values for AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl
func (AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl) Values() []AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl
Values returns all known values for AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl ¶
type AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl string
const ( AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlFollowInput AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl = "FOLLOW_INPUT" AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlUseConfigured AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl = "USE_CONFIGURED" )
Enum values for AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl
func (AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl) Values() []AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl
Values returns all known values for AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AudioLanguageSelection ¶
type AudioLanguageSelection struct { // Selects a specific three-letter language code from within an audio source. // // This member is required. LanguageCode *string // When set to "strict", the transport stream demux strictly identifies audio // streams by their language descriptor. If a PMT update occurs such that an audio // stream matching the initially selected language is no longer present then mute // will be encoded until the language returns. If "loose", then on a PMT update the // demux will choose another audio stream in the program with the same stream type // if it can't find one with the same language. LanguageSelectionPolicy AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy }
Audio Language Selection
type AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy ¶
type AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy string
const ( AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyLoose AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy = "LOOSE" AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyStrict AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy = "STRICT" )
Enum values for AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy
func (AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy) Values() []AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy
Values returns all known values for AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AudioNormalizationAlgorithm ¶
type AudioNormalizationAlgorithm string
const ( AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17701 AudioNormalizationAlgorithm = "ITU_1770_1" AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17702 AudioNormalizationAlgorithm = "ITU_1770_2" )
Enum values for AudioNormalizationAlgorithm
func (AudioNormalizationAlgorithm) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AudioNormalizationAlgorithm) Values() []AudioNormalizationAlgorithm
Values returns all known values for AudioNormalizationAlgorithm. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl ¶
type AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl string
const (
AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControlCorrectAudio AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl = "CORRECT_AUDIO"
)
Enum values for AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl
func (AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl) Values() []AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl
Values returns all known values for AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AudioNormalizationSettings ¶
type AudioNormalizationSettings struct { // Audio normalization algorithm to use. itu17701 conforms to the CALM Act // specification, itu17702 conforms to the EBU R-128 specification. Algorithm AudioNormalizationAlgorithm // When set to correctAudio the output audio is corrected using the chosen // algorithm. If set to measureOnly, the audio will be measured but not adjusted. AlgorithmControl AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl // Target LKFS(loudness) to adjust volume to. If no value is entered, a default // value will be used according to the chosen algorithm. The CALM Act (1770-1) // recommends a target of -24 LKFS. The EBU R-128 specification (1770-2) recommends // a target of -23 LKFS. TargetLkfs float64 }
Audio Normalization Settings
type AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType ¶
type AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType string
const ( AudioOnlyHlsSegmentTypeAac AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType = "AAC" AudioOnlyHlsSegmentTypeFmp4 AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType = "FMP4" )
Enum values for AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType
func (AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType) Values() []AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType
Values returns all known values for AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AudioOnlyHlsSettings ¶
type AudioOnlyHlsSettings struct { // Specifies the group to which the audio Rendition belongs. AudioGroupId *string // Optional. Specifies the .jpg or .png image to use as the cover art for an // audio-only output. We recommend a low bit-size file because the image increases // the output audio bandwidth. The image is attached to the audio as an ID3 tag, // frame type APIC, picture type 0x10, as per the "ID3 tag version 2.4.0 - Native // Frames" standard. AudioOnlyImage *InputLocation // Four types of audio-only tracks are supported: Audio-Only Variant Stream The // client can play back this audio-only stream instead of video in low-bandwidth // scenarios. Represented as an EXT-X-STREAM-INF in the HLS manifest. Alternate // Audio, Auto Select, Default Alternate rendition that the client should try to // play back by default. Represented as an EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest with // DEFAULT=YES, AUTOSELECT=YES Alternate Audio, Auto Select, Not Default Alternate // rendition that the client may try to play back by default. Represented as an // EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest with DEFAULT=NO, AUTOSELECT=YES Alternate Audio, // not Auto Select Alternate rendition that the client will not try to play back by // default. Represented as an EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest with DEFAULT=NO, // AUTOSELECT=NO AudioTrackType AudioOnlyHlsTrackType // Specifies the segment type. SegmentType AudioOnlyHlsSegmentType }
Audio Only Hls Settings
type AudioOnlyHlsTrackType ¶
type AudioOnlyHlsTrackType string
const ( AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelect AudioOnlyHlsTrackType = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_AUTO_SELECT" AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelectDefault AudioOnlyHlsTrackType = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_AUTO_SELECT_DEFAULT" AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioNotAutoSelect AudioOnlyHlsTrackType = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_NOT_AUTO_SELECT" AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAudioOnlyVariantStream AudioOnlyHlsTrackType = "AUDIO_ONLY_VARIANT_STREAM" )
Enum values for AudioOnlyHlsTrackType
func (AudioOnlyHlsTrackType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AudioOnlyHlsTrackType) Values() []AudioOnlyHlsTrackType
Values returns all known values for AudioOnlyHlsTrackType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AudioPidSelection ¶
type AudioPidSelection struct { // Selects a specific PID from within a source. // // This member is required. Pid int32 }
Audio Pid Selection
type AudioSelector ¶
type AudioSelector struct { // The name of this AudioSelector. AudioDescriptions will use this name to uniquely // identify this Selector. Selector names should be unique per input. // // This member is required. Name *string // The audio selector settings. SelectorSettings *AudioSelectorSettings }
Audio Selector
type AudioSelectorSettings ¶
type AudioSelectorSettings struct { // Audio Language Selection AudioLanguageSelection *AudioLanguageSelection // Audio Pid Selection AudioPidSelection *AudioPidSelection // Audio Track Selection AudioTrackSelection *AudioTrackSelection }
Audio Selector Settings
type AudioSilenceFailoverSettings ¶ added in v0.31.0
type AudioSilenceFailoverSettings struct { // The name of the audio selector in the input that MediaLive should monitor to // detect silence. Select your most important rendition. If you didn't create an // audio selector in this input, leave blank. // // This member is required. AudioSelectorName *string // The amount of time (in milliseconds) that the active input must be silent before // automatic input failover occurs. Silence is defined as audio loss or audio // quieter than -50 dBFS. AudioSilenceThresholdMsec int32 }
Placeholder documentation for AudioSilenceFailoverSettings
type AudioTrack ¶
type AudioTrack struct { // 1-based integer value that maps to a specific audio track // // This member is required. Track int32 }
Audio Track
type AudioTrackSelection ¶
type AudioTrackSelection struct { // Selects one or more unique audio tracks from within a source. // // This member is required. Tracks []AudioTrack }
Audio Track Selection
type AudioType ¶
type AudioType string
type AuthenticationScheme ¶
type AuthenticationScheme string
const ( AuthenticationSchemeAkamai AuthenticationScheme = "AKAMAI" AuthenticationSchemeCommon AuthenticationScheme = "COMMON" )
Enum values for AuthenticationScheme
func (AuthenticationScheme) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AuthenticationScheme) Values() []AuthenticationScheme
Values returns all known values for AuthenticationScheme. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AutomaticInputFailoverSettings ¶
type AutomaticInputFailoverSettings struct { // The input ID of the secondary input in the automatic input failover pair. // // This member is required. SecondaryInputId *string // This clear time defines the requirement a recovered input must meet to be // considered healthy. The input must have no failover conditions for this length // of time. Enter a time in milliseconds. This value is particularly important if // the input_preference for the failover pair is set to PRIMARY_INPUT_PREFERRED, // because after this time, MediaLive will switch back to the primary input. ErrorClearTimeMsec int32 // A list of failover conditions. If any of these conditions occur, MediaLive will // perform a failover to the other input. FailoverConditions []FailoverCondition // Input preference when deciding which input to make active when a previously // failed input has recovered. InputPreference InputPreference }
The settings for Automatic Input Failover.
type AvailBlanking ¶
type AvailBlanking struct { // Blanking image to be used. Leave empty for solid black. Only bmp and png images // are supported. AvailBlankingImage *InputLocation // When set to enabled, causes video, audio and captions to be blanked when // insertion metadata is added. State AvailBlankingState }
Avail Blanking
type AvailBlankingState ¶
type AvailBlankingState string
const ( AvailBlankingStateDisabled AvailBlankingState = "DISABLED" AvailBlankingStateEnabled AvailBlankingState = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for AvailBlankingState
func (AvailBlankingState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (AvailBlankingState) Values() []AvailBlankingState
Values returns all known values for AvailBlankingState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type AvailConfiguration ¶
type AvailConfiguration struct { // Ad avail settings. AvailSettings *AvailSettings }
Avail Configuration
type AvailSettings ¶
type AvailSettings struct { // Scte35 Splice Insert Scte35SpliceInsert *Scte35SpliceInsert // Scte35 Time Signal Apos Scte35TimeSignalApos *Scte35TimeSignalApos }
Avail Settings
type BadGatewayException ¶
type BadGatewayException struct {
Message *string
}
Placeholder documentation for BadGatewayException
func (*BadGatewayException) Error ¶
func (e *BadGatewayException) Error() string
func (*BadGatewayException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *BadGatewayException) ErrorCode() string
func (*BadGatewayException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *BadGatewayException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*BadGatewayException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *BadGatewayException) ErrorMessage() string
type BadRequestException ¶
type BadRequestException struct {
Message *string
}
Placeholder documentation for BadRequestException
func (*BadRequestException) Error ¶
func (e *BadRequestException) Error() string
func (*BadRequestException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *BadRequestException) ErrorCode() string
func (*BadRequestException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *BadRequestException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*BadRequestException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *BadRequestException) ErrorMessage() string
type BatchFailedResultModel ¶ added in v0.29.0
type BatchFailedResultModel struct { // ARN of the resource Arn *string // Error code for the failed operation Code *string // ID of the resource Id *string // Error message for the failed operation Message *string }
Details from a failed operation
type BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest ¶
type BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest struct { // A list of schedule actions to create. // // This member is required. ScheduleActions []ScheduleAction }
A list of schedule actions to create (in a request) or that have been created (in a response).
type BatchScheduleActionCreateResult ¶
type BatchScheduleActionCreateResult struct { // List of actions that have been created in the schedule. // // This member is required. ScheduleActions []ScheduleAction }
List of actions that have been created in the schedule.
type BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest ¶
type BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest struct { // A list of schedule actions to delete. // // This member is required. ActionNames []string }
A list of schedule actions to delete.
type BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult ¶
type BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult struct { // List of actions that have been deleted from the schedule. // // This member is required. ScheduleActions []ScheduleAction }
List of actions that have been deleted from the schedule.
type BatchSuccessfulResultModel ¶ added in v0.29.0
type BatchSuccessfulResultModel struct { // ARN of the resource Arn *string // ID of the resource Id *string // Current state of the resource State *string }
Details from a successful operation
type BlackoutSlate ¶
type BlackoutSlate struct { // Blackout slate image to be used. Leave empty for solid black. Only bmp and png // images are supported. BlackoutSlateImage *InputLocation // Setting to enabled causes the encoder to blackout the video, audio, and // captions, and raise the "Network Blackout Image" slate when an SCTE104/35 // Network End Segmentation Descriptor is encountered. The blackout will be lifted // when the Network Start Segmentation Descriptor is encountered. The Network End // and Network Start descriptors must contain a network ID that matches the value // entered in "Network ID". NetworkEndBlackout BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout // Path to local file to use as Network End Blackout image. Image will be scaled to // fill the entire output raster. NetworkEndBlackoutImage *InputLocation // Provides Network ID that matches EIDR ID format (e.g., // "10.XXXX/XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-C"). NetworkId *string // When set to enabled, causes video, audio and captions to be blanked when // indicated by program metadata. State BlackoutSlateState }
Blackout Slate
type BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout ¶
type BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout string
const ( BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutDisabled BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout = "DISABLED" BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutEnabled BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout
func (BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout) Values() []BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout
Values returns all known values for BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type BlackoutSlateState ¶
type BlackoutSlateState string
const ( BlackoutSlateStateDisabled BlackoutSlateState = "DISABLED" BlackoutSlateStateEnabled BlackoutSlateState = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for BlackoutSlateState
func (BlackoutSlateState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (BlackoutSlateState) Values() []BlackoutSlateState
Values returns all known values for BlackoutSlateState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type BurnInAlignment ¶
type BurnInAlignment string
const ( BurnInAlignmentCentered BurnInAlignment = "CENTERED" BurnInAlignmentLeft BurnInAlignment = "LEFT" BurnInAlignmentSmart BurnInAlignment = "SMART" )
Enum values for BurnInAlignment
func (BurnInAlignment) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (BurnInAlignment) Values() []BurnInAlignment
Values returns all known values for BurnInAlignment. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type BurnInBackgroundColor ¶
type BurnInBackgroundColor string
const ( BurnInBackgroundColorBlack BurnInBackgroundColor = "BLACK" BurnInBackgroundColorNone BurnInBackgroundColor = "NONE" BurnInBackgroundColorWhite BurnInBackgroundColor = "WHITE" )
Enum values for BurnInBackgroundColor
func (BurnInBackgroundColor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (BurnInBackgroundColor) Values() []BurnInBackgroundColor
Values returns all known values for BurnInBackgroundColor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type BurnInDestinationSettings ¶
type BurnInDestinationSettings struct { // If no explicit xPosition or yPosition is provided, setting alignment to centered // will place the captions at the bottom center of the output. Similarly, setting a // left alignment will align captions to the bottom left of the output. If x and y // positions are given in conjunction with the alignment parameter, the font will // be justified (either left or centered) relative to those coordinates. Selecting // "smart" justification will left-justify live subtitles and center-justify // pre-recorded subtitles. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. Alignment BurnInAlignment // Specifies the color of the rectangle behind the captions. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. BackgroundColor BurnInBackgroundColor // Specifies the opacity of the background rectangle. 255 is opaque; 0 is // transparent. Leaving this parameter out is equivalent to setting it to 0 // (transparent). All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. BackgroundOpacity int32 // External font file used for caption burn-in. File extension must be 'ttf' or // 'tte'. Although the user can select output fonts for many different types of // input captions, embedded, STL and teletext sources use a strict grid system. // Using external fonts with these caption sources could cause unexpected display // of proportional fonts. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. Font *InputLocation // Specifies the color of the burned-in captions. This option is not valid for // source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings // are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font // settings must match. FontColor BurnInFontColor // Specifies the opacity of the burned-in captions. 255 is opaque; 0 is // transparent. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontOpacity int32 // Font resolution in DPI (dots per inch); default is 96 dpi. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontResolution int32 // When set to 'auto' fontSize will scale depending on the size of the output. // Giving a positive integer will specify the exact font size in points. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontSize *string // Specifies font outline color. This option is not valid for source captions that // are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are already // pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must // match. OutlineColor BurnInOutlineColor // Specifies font outline size in pixels. This option is not valid for source // captions that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are // already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings // must match. OutlineSize int32 // Specifies the color of the shadow cast by the captions. All burn-in and DVB-Sub // font settings must match. ShadowColor BurnInShadowColor // Specifies the opacity of the shadow. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. Leaving // this parameter out is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent). All burn-in // and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowOpacity int32 // Specifies the horizontal offset of the shadow relative to the captions in // pixels. A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels to the left. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowXOffset int32 // Specifies the vertical offset of the shadow relative to the captions in pixels. // A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels above the text. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowYOffset int32 // Controls whether a fixed grid size will be used to generate the output subtitles // bitmap. Only applicable for Teletext inputs and DVB-Sub/Burn-in outputs. TeletextGridControl BurnInTeletextGridControl // Specifies the horizontal position of the caption relative to the left side of // the output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting 10 // pixels from the left of the output. If no explicit xPosition is provided, the // horizontal caption position will be determined by the alignment parameter. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. XPosition int32 // Specifies the vertical position of the caption relative to the top of the output // in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting 10 pixels from // the top of the output. If no explicit yPosition is provided, the caption will be // positioned towards the bottom of the output. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font // settings must match. YPosition int32 }
Burn In Destination Settings
type BurnInFontColor ¶
type BurnInFontColor string
const ( BurnInFontColorBlack BurnInFontColor = "BLACK" BurnInFontColorBlue BurnInFontColor = "BLUE" BurnInFontColorGreen BurnInFontColor = "GREEN" BurnInFontColorRed BurnInFontColor = "RED" BurnInFontColorWhite BurnInFontColor = "WHITE" BurnInFontColorYellow BurnInFontColor = "YELLOW" )
Enum values for BurnInFontColor
func (BurnInFontColor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (BurnInFontColor) Values() []BurnInFontColor
Values returns all known values for BurnInFontColor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type BurnInOutlineColor ¶
type BurnInOutlineColor string
const ( BurnInOutlineColorBlack BurnInOutlineColor = "BLACK" BurnInOutlineColorBlue BurnInOutlineColor = "BLUE" BurnInOutlineColorGreen BurnInOutlineColor = "GREEN" BurnInOutlineColorRed BurnInOutlineColor = "RED" BurnInOutlineColorWhite BurnInOutlineColor = "WHITE" BurnInOutlineColorYellow BurnInOutlineColor = "YELLOW" )
Enum values for BurnInOutlineColor
func (BurnInOutlineColor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (BurnInOutlineColor) Values() []BurnInOutlineColor
Values returns all known values for BurnInOutlineColor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type BurnInShadowColor ¶
type BurnInShadowColor string
const ( BurnInShadowColorBlack BurnInShadowColor = "BLACK" BurnInShadowColorNone BurnInShadowColor = "NONE" BurnInShadowColorWhite BurnInShadowColor = "WHITE" )
Enum values for BurnInShadowColor
func (BurnInShadowColor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (BurnInShadowColor) Values() []BurnInShadowColor
Values returns all known values for BurnInShadowColor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type BurnInTeletextGridControl ¶
type BurnInTeletextGridControl string
const ( BurnInTeletextGridControlFixed BurnInTeletextGridControl = "FIXED" BurnInTeletextGridControlScaled BurnInTeletextGridControl = "SCALED" )
Enum values for BurnInTeletextGridControl
func (BurnInTeletextGridControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (BurnInTeletextGridControl) Values() []BurnInTeletextGridControl
Values returns all known values for BurnInTeletextGridControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type CaptionDescription ¶
type CaptionDescription struct { // Specifies which input caption selector to use as a caption source when // generating output captions. This field should match a captionSelector name. // // This member is required. CaptionSelectorName *string // Name of the caption description. Used to associate a caption description with an // output. Names must be unique within an event. // // This member is required. Name *string // Additional settings for captions destination that depend on the destination // type. DestinationSettings *CaptionDestinationSettings // ISO 639-2 three-digit code: http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2/ LanguageCode *string // Human readable information to indicate captions available for players (eg. // English, or Spanish). LanguageDescription *string }
Caption Description
type CaptionDestinationSettings ¶
type CaptionDestinationSettings struct { // Arib Destination Settings AribDestinationSettings *AribDestinationSettings // Burn In Destination Settings BurnInDestinationSettings *BurnInDestinationSettings // Dvb Sub Destination Settings DvbSubDestinationSettings *DvbSubDestinationSettings // Ebu Tt DDestination Settings EbuTtDDestinationSettings *EbuTtDDestinationSettings // Embedded Destination Settings EmbeddedDestinationSettings *EmbeddedDestinationSettings // Embedded Plus Scte20 Destination Settings EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings *EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings // Rtmp Caption Info Destination Settings RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings *RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings // Scte20 Plus Embedded Destination Settings Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings *Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings // Scte27 Destination Settings Scte27DestinationSettings *Scte27DestinationSettings // Smpte Tt Destination Settings SmpteTtDestinationSettings *SmpteTtDestinationSettings // Teletext Destination Settings TeletextDestinationSettings *TeletextDestinationSettings // Ttml Destination Settings TtmlDestinationSettings *TtmlDestinationSettings // Webvtt Destination Settings WebvttDestinationSettings *WebvttDestinationSettings }
Caption Destination Settings
type CaptionLanguageMapping ¶
type CaptionLanguageMapping struct { // The closed caption channel being described by this CaptionLanguageMapping. Each // channel mapping must have a unique channel number (maximum of 4) // // This member is required. CaptionChannel int32 // Three character ISO 639-2 language code (see // http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2) // // This member is required. LanguageCode *string // Textual description of language // // This member is required. LanguageDescription *string }
Maps a caption channel to an ISO 693-2 language code (http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2), with an optional description.
type CaptionRectangle ¶ added in v1.2.0
type CaptionRectangle struct { // See the description in leftOffset. For height, specify the entire height of the // rectangle as a percentage of the underlying frame height. For example, "80" // means the rectangle height is 80% of the underlying frame height. The topOffset // and rectangleHeight must add up to 100% or less. This field corresponds to // tts:extent - Y in the TTML standard. // // This member is required. Height float64 // Applies only if you plan to convert these source captions to EBU-TT-D or TTML in // an output. (Make sure to leave the default if you don't have either of these // formats in the output.) You can define a display rectangle for the captions that // is smaller than the underlying video frame. You define the rectangle by // specifying the position of the left edge, top edge, bottom edge, and right edge // of the rectangle, all within the underlying video frame. The units for the // measurements are percentages. If you specify a value for one of these fields, // you must specify a value for all of them. For leftOffset, specify the position // of the left edge of the rectangle, as a percentage of the underlying frame // width, and relative to the left edge of the frame. For example, "10" means the // measurement is 10% of the underlying frame width. The rectangle left edge starts // at that position from the left edge of the frame. This field corresponds to // tts:origin - X in the TTML standard. // // This member is required. LeftOffset float64 // See the description in leftOffset. For topOffset, specify the position of the // top edge of the rectangle, as a percentage of the underlying frame height, and // relative to the top edge of the frame. For example, "10" means the measurement // is 10% of the underlying frame height. The rectangle top edge starts at that // position from the top edge of the frame. This field corresponds to tts:origin - // Y in the TTML standard. // // This member is required. TopOffset float64 // See the description in leftOffset. For width, specify the entire width of the // rectangle as a percentage of the underlying frame width. For example, "80" means // the rectangle width is 80% of the underlying frame width. The leftOffset and // rectangleWidth must add up to 100% or less. This field corresponds to tts:extent // - X in the TTML standard. // // This member is required. Width float64 }
Caption Rectangle
type CaptionSelector ¶
type CaptionSelector struct { // Name identifier for a caption selector. This name is used to associate this // caption selector with one or more caption descriptions. Names must be unique // within an event. // // This member is required. Name *string // When specified this field indicates the three letter language code of the // caption track to extract from the source. LanguageCode *string // Caption selector settings. SelectorSettings *CaptionSelectorSettings }
Output groups for this Live Event. Output groups contain information about where streams should be distributed.
type CaptionSelectorSettings ¶
type CaptionSelectorSettings struct { // Ancillary Source Settings AncillarySourceSettings *AncillarySourceSettings // Arib Source Settings AribSourceSettings *AribSourceSettings // Dvb Sub Source Settings DvbSubSourceSettings *DvbSubSourceSettings // Embedded Source Settings EmbeddedSourceSettings *EmbeddedSourceSettings // Scte20 Source Settings Scte20SourceSettings *Scte20SourceSettings // Scte27 Source Settings Scte27SourceSettings *Scte27SourceSettings // Teletext Source Settings TeletextSourceSettings *TeletextSourceSettings }
Caption Selector Settings
type CdiInputResolution ¶ added in v0.29.0
type CdiInputResolution string
const ( CdiInputResolutionSd CdiInputResolution = "SD" CdiInputResolutionHd CdiInputResolution = "HD" CdiInputResolutionFhd CdiInputResolution = "FHD" CdiInputResolutionUhd CdiInputResolution = "UHD" )
Enum values for CdiInputResolution
func (CdiInputResolution) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (CdiInputResolution) Values() []CdiInputResolution
Values returns all known values for CdiInputResolution. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type CdiInputSpecification ¶ added in v0.29.0
type CdiInputSpecification struct { // Maximum CDI input resolution Resolution CdiInputResolution }
Placeholder documentation for CdiInputSpecification
type Channel ¶
type Channel struct { // The unique arn of the channel. Arn *string // Specification of CDI inputs for this channel CdiInputSpecification *CdiInputSpecification // The class for this channel. STANDARD for a channel with two pipelines or // SINGLE_PIPELINE for a channel with one pipeline. ChannelClass ChannelClass // A list of destinations of the channel. For UDP outputs, there is one destination // per output. For other types (HLS, for example), there is one destination per // packager. Destinations []OutputDestination // The endpoints where outgoing connections initiate from EgressEndpoints []ChannelEgressEndpoint // Encoder Settings EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings // The unique id of the channel. Id *string // List of input attachments for channel. InputAttachments []InputAttachment // Specification of network and file inputs for this channel InputSpecification *InputSpecification // The log level being written to CloudWatch Logs. LogLevel LogLevel // The name of the channel. (user-mutable) Name *string // Runtime details for the pipelines of a running channel. PipelineDetails []PipelineDetail // The number of currently healthy pipelines. PipelinesRunningCount int32 // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role assumed when running the Channel. RoleArn *string // Placeholder documentation for ChannelState State ChannelState // A collection of key-value pairs. Tags map[string]string // Settings for VPC output Vpc *VpcOutputSettingsDescription }
Placeholder documentation for Channel
type ChannelClass ¶
type ChannelClass string
const ( ChannelClassStandard ChannelClass = "STANDARD" ChannelClassSinglePipeline ChannelClass = "SINGLE_PIPELINE" )
Enum values for ChannelClass
func (ChannelClass) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ChannelClass) Values() []ChannelClass
Values returns all known values for ChannelClass. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ChannelEgressEndpoint ¶
type ChannelEgressEndpoint struct { // Public IP of where a channel's output comes from SourceIp *string }
Placeholder documentation for ChannelEgressEndpoint
type ChannelState ¶
type ChannelState string
const ( ChannelStateCreating ChannelState = "CREATING" ChannelStateCreateFailed ChannelState = "CREATE_FAILED" ChannelStateIdle ChannelState = "IDLE" ChannelStateStarting ChannelState = "STARTING" ChannelStateRunning ChannelState = "RUNNING" ChannelStateRecovering ChannelState = "RECOVERING" ChannelStateStopping ChannelState = "STOPPING" ChannelStateDeleting ChannelState = "DELETING" ChannelStateDeleted ChannelState = "DELETED" ChannelStateUpdating ChannelState = "UPDATING" ChannelStateUpdateFailed ChannelState = "UPDATE_FAILED" )
Enum values for ChannelState
func (ChannelState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ChannelState) Values() []ChannelState
Values returns all known values for ChannelState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ChannelSummary ¶
type ChannelSummary struct { // The unique arn of the channel. Arn *string // Specification of CDI inputs for this channel CdiInputSpecification *CdiInputSpecification // The class for this channel. STANDARD for a channel with two pipelines or // SINGLE_PIPELINE for a channel with one pipeline. ChannelClass ChannelClass // A list of destinations of the channel. For UDP outputs, there is one destination // per output. For other types (HLS, for example), there is one destination per // packager. Destinations []OutputDestination // The endpoints where outgoing connections initiate from EgressEndpoints []ChannelEgressEndpoint // The unique id of the channel. Id *string // List of input attachments for channel. InputAttachments []InputAttachment // Specification of network and file inputs for this channel InputSpecification *InputSpecification // The log level being written to CloudWatch Logs. LogLevel LogLevel // The name of the channel. (user-mutable) Name *string // The number of currently healthy pipelines. PipelinesRunningCount int32 // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role assumed when running the Channel. RoleArn *string // Placeholder documentation for ChannelState State ChannelState // A collection of key-value pairs. Tags map[string]string // Settings for VPC output Vpc *VpcOutputSettingsDescription }
Placeholder documentation for ChannelSummary
type ColorSpacePassthroughSettings ¶
type ColorSpacePassthroughSettings struct { }
Passthrough applies no color space conversion to the output
type ConflictException ¶
type ConflictException struct {
Message *string
}
Placeholder documentation for ConflictException
func (*ConflictException) Error ¶
func (e *ConflictException) Error() string
func (*ConflictException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *ConflictException) ErrorCode() string
func (*ConflictException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *ConflictException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*ConflictException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *ConflictException) ErrorMessage() string
type ContentType ¶
type ContentType string
const (
ContentTypeImageJpeg ContentType = "image/jpeg"
)
Enum values for ContentType
func (ContentType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ContentType) Values() []ContentType
Values returns all known values for ContentType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DeviceSettingsSyncState ¶
type DeviceSettingsSyncState string
const ( DeviceSettingsSyncStateSynced DeviceSettingsSyncState = "SYNCED" DeviceSettingsSyncStateSyncing DeviceSettingsSyncState = "SYNCING" )
Enum values for DeviceSettingsSyncState
func (DeviceSettingsSyncState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (DeviceSettingsSyncState) Values() []DeviceSettingsSyncState
Values returns all known values for DeviceSettingsSyncState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DeviceUpdateStatus ¶ added in v0.30.0
type DeviceUpdateStatus string
const ( DeviceUpdateStatusUpToDate DeviceUpdateStatus = "UP_TO_DATE" DeviceUpdateStatusNotUpToDate DeviceUpdateStatus = "NOT_UP_TO_DATE" )
Enum values for DeviceUpdateStatus
func (DeviceUpdateStatus) Values ¶ added in v0.30.0
func (DeviceUpdateStatus) Values() []DeviceUpdateStatus
Values returns all known values for DeviceUpdateStatus. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DvbNitSettings ¶
type DvbNitSettings struct { // The numeric value placed in the Network Information Table (NIT). // // This member is required. NetworkId int32 // The network name text placed in the networkNameDescriptor inside the Network // Information Table. Maximum length is 256 characters. // // This member is required. NetworkName *string // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. RepInterval int32 }
DVB Network Information Table (NIT)
type DvbSdtOutputSdt ¶
type DvbSdtOutputSdt string
const ( DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollow DvbSdtOutputSdt = "SDT_FOLLOW" DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollowIfPresent DvbSdtOutputSdt = "SDT_FOLLOW_IF_PRESENT" DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtManual DvbSdtOutputSdt = "SDT_MANUAL" DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtNone DvbSdtOutputSdt = "SDT_NONE" )
Enum values for DvbSdtOutputSdt
func (DvbSdtOutputSdt) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (DvbSdtOutputSdt) Values() []DvbSdtOutputSdt
Values returns all known values for DvbSdtOutputSdt. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DvbSdtSettings ¶
type DvbSdtSettings struct { // Selects method of inserting SDT information into output stream. The sdtFollow // setting copies SDT information from input stream to output stream. The // sdtFollowIfPresent setting copies SDT information from input stream to output // stream if SDT information is present in the input, otherwise it will fall back // on the user-defined values. The sdtManual setting means user will enter the SDT // information. The sdtNone setting means output stream will not contain SDT // information. OutputSdt DvbSdtOutputSdt // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. RepInterval int32 // The service name placed in the serviceDescriptor in the Service Description // Table. Maximum length is 256 characters. ServiceName *string // The service provider name placed in the serviceDescriptor in the Service // Description Table. Maximum length is 256 characters. ServiceProviderName *string }
DVB Service Description Table (SDT)
type DvbSubDestinationAlignment ¶
type DvbSubDestinationAlignment string
const ( DvbSubDestinationAlignmentCentered DvbSubDestinationAlignment = "CENTERED" DvbSubDestinationAlignmentLeft DvbSubDestinationAlignment = "LEFT" DvbSubDestinationAlignmentSmart DvbSubDestinationAlignment = "SMART" )
Enum values for DvbSubDestinationAlignment
func (DvbSubDestinationAlignment) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (DvbSubDestinationAlignment) Values() []DvbSubDestinationAlignment
Values returns all known values for DvbSubDestinationAlignment. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor ¶
type DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor string
const ( DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorBlack DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor = "BLACK" DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorNone DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor = "NONE" DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorWhite DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor = "WHITE" )
Enum values for DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor
func (DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor) Values() []DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor
Values returns all known values for DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DvbSubDestinationFontColor ¶
type DvbSubDestinationFontColor string
const ( DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlack DvbSubDestinationFontColor = "BLACK" DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlue DvbSubDestinationFontColor = "BLUE" DvbSubDestinationFontColorGreen DvbSubDestinationFontColor = "GREEN" DvbSubDestinationFontColorRed DvbSubDestinationFontColor = "RED" DvbSubDestinationFontColorWhite DvbSubDestinationFontColor = "WHITE" DvbSubDestinationFontColorYellow DvbSubDestinationFontColor = "YELLOW" )
Enum values for DvbSubDestinationFontColor
func (DvbSubDestinationFontColor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (DvbSubDestinationFontColor) Values() []DvbSubDestinationFontColor
Values returns all known values for DvbSubDestinationFontColor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor ¶
type DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor string
const ( DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlack DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor = "BLACK" DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlue DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor = "BLUE" DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorGreen DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor = "GREEN" DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorRed DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor = "RED" DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorWhite DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor = "WHITE" DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorYellow DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor = "YELLOW" )
Enum values for DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor
func (DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor) Values() []DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor
Values returns all known values for DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DvbSubDestinationSettings ¶
type DvbSubDestinationSettings struct { // If no explicit xPosition or yPosition is provided, setting alignment to centered // will place the captions at the bottom center of the output. Similarly, setting a // left alignment will align captions to the bottom left of the output. If x and y // positions are given in conjunction with the alignment parameter, the font will // be justified (either left or centered) relative to those coordinates. Selecting // "smart" justification will left-justify live subtitles and center-justify // pre-recorded subtitles. This option is not valid for source captions that are // STL or 608/embedded. These source settings are already pre-defined by the // caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. Alignment DvbSubDestinationAlignment // Specifies the color of the rectangle behind the captions. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. BackgroundColor DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor // Specifies the opacity of the background rectangle. 255 is opaque; 0 is // transparent. Leaving this parameter blank is equivalent to setting it to 0 // (transparent). All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. BackgroundOpacity int32 // External font file used for caption burn-in. File extension must be 'ttf' or // 'tte'. Although the user can select output fonts for many different types of // input captions, embedded, STL and teletext sources use a strict grid system. // Using external fonts with these caption sources could cause unexpected display // of proportional fonts. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. Font *InputLocation // Specifies the color of the burned-in captions. This option is not valid for // source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings // are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font // settings must match. FontColor DvbSubDestinationFontColor // Specifies the opacity of the burned-in captions. 255 is opaque; 0 is // transparent. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontOpacity int32 // Font resolution in DPI (dots per inch); default is 96 dpi. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontResolution int32 // When set to auto fontSize will scale depending on the size of the output. Giving // a positive integer will specify the exact font size in points. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontSize *string // Specifies font outline color. This option is not valid for source captions that // are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are already // pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must // match. OutlineColor DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor // Specifies font outline size in pixels. This option is not valid for source // captions that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are // already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings // must match. OutlineSize int32 // Specifies the color of the shadow cast by the captions. All burn-in and DVB-Sub // font settings must match. ShadowColor DvbSubDestinationShadowColor // Specifies the opacity of the shadow. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. Leaving // this parameter blank is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent). All burn-in // and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowOpacity int32 // Specifies the horizontal offset of the shadow relative to the captions in // pixels. A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels to the left. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowXOffset int32 // Specifies the vertical offset of the shadow relative to the captions in pixels. // A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels above the text. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowYOffset int32 // Controls whether a fixed grid size will be used to generate the output subtitles // bitmap. Only applicable for Teletext inputs and DVB-Sub/Burn-in outputs. TeletextGridControl DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl // Specifies the horizontal position of the caption relative to the left side of // the output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting 10 // pixels from the left of the output. If no explicit xPosition is provided, the // horizontal caption position will be determined by the alignment parameter. This // option is not valid for source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. // These source settings are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in // and DVB-Sub font settings must match. XPosition int32 // Specifies the vertical position of the caption relative to the top of the output // in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting 10 pixels from // the top of the output. If no explicit yPosition is provided, the caption will be // positioned towards the bottom of the output. This option is not valid for source // captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are // already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings // must match. YPosition int32 }
Dvb Sub Destination Settings
type DvbSubDestinationShadowColor ¶
type DvbSubDestinationShadowColor string
const ( DvbSubDestinationShadowColorBlack DvbSubDestinationShadowColor = "BLACK" DvbSubDestinationShadowColorNone DvbSubDestinationShadowColor = "NONE" DvbSubDestinationShadowColorWhite DvbSubDestinationShadowColor = "WHITE" )
Enum values for DvbSubDestinationShadowColor
func (DvbSubDestinationShadowColor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (DvbSubDestinationShadowColor) Values() []DvbSubDestinationShadowColor
Values returns all known values for DvbSubDestinationShadowColor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl ¶
type DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl string
const ( DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlFixed DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl = "FIXED" DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlScaled DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl = "SCALED" )
Enum values for DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl
func (DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl) Values() []DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl
Values returns all known values for DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type DvbSubSourceSettings ¶
type DvbSubSourceSettings struct { // When using DVB-Sub with Burn-In or SMPTE-TT, use this PID for the source // content. Unused for DVB-Sub passthrough. All DVB-Sub content is passed through, // regardless of selectors. Pid int32 }
Dvb Sub Source Settings
type DvbTdtSettings ¶
type DvbTdtSettings struct { // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. RepInterval int32 }
DVB Time and Date Table (SDT)
type Eac3AttenuationControl ¶
type Eac3AttenuationControl string
const ( Eac3AttenuationControlAttenuate3Db Eac3AttenuationControl = "ATTENUATE_3_DB" Eac3AttenuationControlNone Eac3AttenuationControl = "NONE" )
Enum values for Eac3AttenuationControl
func (Eac3AttenuationControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3AttenuationControl) Values() []Eac3AttenuationControl
Values returns all known values for Eac3AttenuationControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3BitstreamMode ¶
type Eac3BitstreamMode string
const ( Eac3BitstreamModeCommentary Eac3BitstreamMode = "COMMENTARY" Eac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain Eac3BitstreamMode = "COMPLETE_MAIN" Eac3BitstreamModeEmergency Eac3BitstreamMode = "EMERGENCY" Eac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired Eac3BitstreamMode = "HEARING_IMPAIRED" Eac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired Eac3BitstreamMode = "VISUALLY_IMPAIRED" )
Enum values for Eac3BitstreamMode
func (Eac3BitstreamMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3BitstreamMode) Values() []Eac3BitstreamMode
Values returns all known values for Eac3BitstreamMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3CodingMode ¶
type Eac3CodingMode string
const ( Eac3CodingModeCodingMode10 Eac3CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_1_0" Eac3CodingModeCodingMode20 Eac3CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_2_0" Eac3CodingModeCodingMode32 Eac3CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_3_2" )
Enum values for Eac3CodingMode
func (Eac3CodingMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3CodingMode) Values() []Eac3CodingMode
Values returns all known values for Eac3CodingMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3DcFilter ¶
type Eac3DcFilter string
const ( Eac3DcFilterDisabled Eac3DcFilter = "DISABLED" Eac3DcFilterEnabled Eac3DcFilter = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for Eac3DcFilter
func (Eac3DcFilter) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3DcFilter) Values() []Eac3DcFilter
Values returns all known values for Eac3DcFilter. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3DrcLine ¶
type Eac3DrcLine string
const ( Eac3DrcLineFilmLight Eac3DrcLine = "FILM_LIGHT" Eac3DrcLineFilmStandard Eac3DrcLine = "FILM_STANDARD" Eac3DrcLineMusicLight Eac3DrcLine = "MUSIC_LIGHT" Eac3DrcLineMusicStandard Eac3DrcLine = "MUSIC_STANDARD" Eac3DrcLineNone Eac3DrcLine = "NONE" Eac3DrcLineSpeech Eac3DrcLine = "SPEECH" )
Enum values for Eac3DrcLine
func (Eac3DrcLine) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3DrcLine) Values() []Eac3DrcLine
Values returns all known values for Eac3DrcLine. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3DrcRf ¶
type Eac3DrcRf string
type Eac3LfeControl ¶
type Eac3LfeControl string
const ( Eac3LfeControlLfe Eac3LfeControl = "LFE" Eac3LfeControlNoLfe Eac3LfeControl = "NO_LFE" )
Enum values for Eac3LfeControl
func (Eac3LfeControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3LfeControl) Values() []Eac3LfeControl
Values returns all known values for Eac3LfeControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3LfeFilter ¶
type Eac3LfeFilter string
const ( Eac3LfeFilterDisabled Eac3LfeFilter = "DISABLED" Eac3LfeFilterEnabled Eac3LfeFilter = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for Eac3LfeFilter
func (Eac3LfeFilter) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3LfeFilter) Values() []Eac3LfeFilter
Values returns all known values for Eac3LfeFilter. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3MetadataControl ¶
type Eac3MetadataControl string
const ( Eac3MetadataControlFollowInput Eac3MetadataControl = "FOLLOW_INPUT" Eac3MetadataControlUseConfigured Eac3MetadataControl = "USE_CONFIGURED" )
Enum values for Eac3MetadataControl
func (Eac3MetadataControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3MetadataControl) Values() []Eac3MetadataControl
Values returns all known values for Eac3MetadataControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3PassthroughControl ¶
type Eac3PassthroughControl string
const ( Eac3PassthroughControlNoPassthrough Eac3PassthroughControl = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" Eac3PassthroughControlWhenPossible Eac3PassthroughControl = "WHEN_POSSIBLE" )
Enum values for Eac3PassthroughControl
func (Eac3PassthroughControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3PassthroughControl) Values() []Eac3PassthroughControl
Values returns all known values for Eac3PassthroughControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3PhaseControl ¶
type Eac3PhaseControl string
const ( Eac3PhaseControlNoShift Eac3PhaseControl = "NO_SHIFT" Eac3PhaseControlShift90Degrees Eac3PhaseControl = "SHIFT_90_DEGREES" )
Enum values for Eac3PhaseControl
func (Eac3PhaseControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3PhaseControl) Values() []Eac3PhaseControl
Values returns all known values for Eac3PhaseControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3Settings ¶
type Eac3Settings struct { // When set to attenuate3Db, applies a 3 dB attenuation to the surround channels. // Only used for 3/2 coding mode. AttenuationControl Eac3AttenuationControl // Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid bitrates depend on the coding mode. Bitrate float64 // Specifies the bitstream mode (bsmod) for the emitted E-AC-3 stream. See ATSC // A/52-2012 (Annex E) for background on these values. BitstreamMode Eac3BitstreamMode // Dolby Digital Plus coding mode. Determines number of channels. CodingMode Eac3CodingMode // When set to enabled, activates a DC highpass filter for all input channels. DcFilter Eac3DcFilter // Sets the dialnorm for the output. If blank and input audio is Dolby Digital // Plus, dialnorm will be passed through. Dialnorm int32 // Sets the Dolby dynamic range compression profile. DrcLine Eac3DrcLine // Sets the profile for heavy Dolby dynamic range compression, ensures that the // instantaneous signal peaks do not exceed specified levels. DrcRf Eac3DrcRf // When encoding 3/2 audio, setting to lfe enables the LFE channel LfeControl Eac3LfeControl // When set to enabled, applies a 120Hz lowpass filter to the LFE channel prior to // encoding. Only valid with codingMode32 coding mode. LfeFilter Eac3LfeFilter // Left only/Right only center mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. LoRoCenterMixLevel float64 // Left only/Right only surround mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. LoRoSurroundMixLevel float64 // Left total/Right total center mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. LtRtCenterMixLevel float64 // Left total/Right total surround mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. LtRtSurroundMixLevel float64 // When set to followInput, encoder metadata will be sourced from the DD, DD+, or // DolbyE decoder that supplied this audio data. If audio was not supplied from one // of these streams, then the static metadata settings will be used. MetadataControl Eac3MetadataControl // When set to whenPossible, input DD+ audio will be passed through if it is // present on the input. This detection is dynamic over the life of the transcode. // Inputs that alternate between DD+ and non-DD+ content will have a consistent DD+ // output as the system alternates between passthrough and encoding. PassthroughControl Eac3PassthroughControl // When set to shift90Degrees, applies a 90-degree phase shift to the surround // channels. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. PhaseControl Eac3PhaseControl // Stereo downmix preference. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. StereoDownmix Eac3StereoDownmix // When encoding 3/2 audio, sets whether an extra center back surround channel is // matrix encoded into the left and right surround channels. SurroundExMode Eac3SurroundExMode // When encoding 2/0 audio, sets whether Dolby Surround is matrix encoded into the // two channels. SurroundMode Eac3SurroundMode }
Eac3 Settings
type Eac3StereoDownmix ¶
type Eac3StereoDownmix string
const ( Eac3StereoDownmixDpl2 Eac3StereoDownmix = "DPL2" Eac3StereoDownmixLoRo Eac3StereoDownmix = "LO_RO" Eac3StereoDownmixLtRt Eac3StereoDownmix = "LT_RT" Eac3StereoDownmixNotIndicated Eac3StereoDownmix = "NOT_INDICATED" )
Enum values for Eac3StereoDownmix
func (Eac3StereoDownmix) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3StereoDownmix) Values() []Eac3StereoDownmix
Values returns all known values for Eac3StereoDownmix. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3SurroundExMode ¶
type Eac3SurroundExMode string
const ( Eac3SurroundExModeDisabled Eac3SurroundExMode = "DISABLED" Eac3SurroundExModeEnabled Eac3SurroundExMode = "ENABLED" Eac3SurroundExModeNotIndicated Eac3SurroundExMode = "NOT_INDICATED" )
Enum values for Eac3SurroundExMode
func (Eac3SurroundExMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3SurroundExMode) Values() []Eac3SurroundExMode
Values returns all known values for Eac3SurroundExMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Eac3SurroundMode ¶
type Eac3SurroundMode string
const ( Eac3SurroundModeDisabled Eac3SurroundMode = "DISABLED" Eac3SurroundModeEnabled Eac3SurroundMode = "ENABLED" Eac3SurroundModeNotIndicated Eac3SurroundMode = "NOT_INDICATED" )
Enum values for Eac3SurroundMode
func (Eac3SurroundMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Eac3SurroundMode) Values() []Eac3SurroundMode
Values returns all known values for Eac3SurroundMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type EbuTtDDestinationSettings ¶
type EbuTtDDestinationSettings struct { // Applies only if you plan to convert these source captions to EBU-TT-D or TTML in // an output. Complete this field if you want to include the name of the copyright // holder in the copyright metadata tag in the TTML CopyrightHolder *string // Specifies how to handle the gap between the lines (in multi-line captions). // // * // enabled: Fill with the captions background color (as specified in the input // captions). // // * disabled: Leave the gap unfilled. FillLineGap EbuTtDFillLineGapControl // Specifies the font family to include in the font data attached to the EBU-TT // captions. Valid only if styleControl is set to include. If you leave this field // empty, the font family is set to "monospaced". (If styleControl is set to // exclude, the font family is always set to "monospaced".) You specify only the // font family. All other style information (color, bold, position and so on) is // copied from the input captions. The size is always set to 100% to allow the // downstream player to choose the size. // // * Enter a list of font families, as a // comma-separated list of font names, in order of preference. The name can be a // font family (such as “Arial”), or a generic font family (such as “serif”), or // “default” (to let the downstream player choose the font). // // * Leave blank to set // the family to “monospace”. FontFamily *string // Specifies the style information (font color, font position, and so on) to // include in the font data that is attached to the EBU-TT captions. // // * include: // Take the style information (font color, font position, and so on) from the // source captions and include that information in the font data attached to the // EBU-TT captions. This option is valid only if the source captions are Embedded // or Teletext. // // * exclude: In the font data attached to the EBU-TT captions, set // the font family to "monospaced". Do not include any other style information. StyleControl EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl }
Ebu Tt DDestination Settings
type EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl ¶
type EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl string
const ( EbuTtDDestinationStyleControlExclude EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl = "EXCLUDE" EbuTtDDestinationStyleControlInclude EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl = "INCLUDE" )
Enum values for EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl
func (EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl) Values() []EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl
Values returns all known values for EbuTtDDestinationStyleControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type EbuTtDFillLineGapControl ¶
type EbuTtDFillLineGapControl string
const ( EbuTtDFillLineGapControlDisabled EbuTtDFillLineGapControl = "DISABLED" EbuTtDFillLineGapControlEnabled EbuTtDFillLineGapControl = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for EbuTtDFillLineGapControl
func (EbuTtDFillLineGapControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (EbuTtDFillLineGapControl) Values() []EbuTtDFillLineGapControl
Values returns all known values for EbuTtDFillLineGapControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type EmbeddedConvert608To708 ¶
type EmbeddedConvert608To708 string
const ( EmbeddedConvert608To708Disabled EmbeddedConvert608To708 = "DISABLED" EmbeddedConvert608To708Upconvert EmbeddedConvert608To708 = "UPCONVERT" )
Enum values for EmbeddedConvert608To708
func (EmbeddedConvert608To708) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (EmbeddedConvert608To708) Values() []EmbeddedConvert608To708
Values returns all known values for EmbeddedConvert608To708. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type EmbeddedDestinationSettings ¶
type EmbeddedDestinationSettings struct { }
Embedded Destination Settings
type EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings ¶
type EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings struct { }
Embedded Plus Scte20 Destination Settings
type EmbeddedScte20Detection ¶
type EmbeddedScte20Detection string
const ( EmbeddedScte20DetectionAuto EmbeddedScte20Detection = "AUTO" EmbeddedScte20DetectionOff EmbeddedScte20Detection = "OFF" )
Enum values for EmbeddedScte20Detection
func (EmbeddedScte20Detection) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (EmbeddedScte20Detection) Values() []EmbeddedScte20Detection
Values returns all known values for EmbeddedScte20Detection. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type EmbeddedSourceSettings ¶
type EmbeddedSourceSettings struct { // If upconvert, 608 data is both passed through via the "608 compatibility bytes" // fields of the 708 wrapper as well as translated into 708. 708 data present in // the source content will be discarded. Convert608To708 EmbeddedConvert608To708 // Set to "auto" to handle streams with intermittent and/or non-aligned SCTE-20 and // Embedded captions. Scte20Detection EmbeddedScte20Detection // Specifies the 608/708 channel number within the video track from which to // extract captions. Unused for passthrough. Source608ChannelNumber int32 // This field is unused and deprecated. Source608TrackNumber int32 }
Embedded Source Settings
type EncoderSettings ¶
type EncoderSettings struct { // Placeholder documentation for __listOfAudioDescription // // This member is required. AudioDescriptions []AudioDescription // Placeholder documentation for __listOfOutputGroup // // This member is required. OutputGroups []OutputGroup // Contains settings used to acquire and adjust timecode information from inputs. // // This member is required. TimecodeConfig *TimecodeConfig // Placeholder documentation for __listOfVideoDescription // // This member is required. VideoDescriptions []VideoDescription // Settings for ad avail blanking. AvailBlanking *AvailBlanking // Event-wide configuration settings for ad avail insertion. AvailConfiguration *AvailConfiguration // Settings for blackout slate. BlackoutSlate *BlackoutSlate // Settings for caption decriptions CaptionDescriptions []CaptionDescription // Feature Activations FeatureActivations *FeatureActivations // Configuration settings that apply to the event as a whole. GlobalConfiguration *GlobalConfiguration // Settings for motion graphics. MotionGraphicsConfiguration *MotionGraphicsConfiguration // Nielsen configuration settings. NielsenConfiguration *NielsenConfiguration }
Encoder Settings
type FailoverCondition ¶ added in v0.29.0
type FailoverCondition struct { // Failover condition type-specific settings. FailoverConditionSettings *FailoverConditionSettings }
Failover Condition settings. There can be multiple failover conditions inside AutomaticInputFailoverSettings.
type FailoverConditionSettings ¶ added in v0.29.0
type FailoverConditionSettings struct { // MediaLive will perform a failover if the specified audio selector is silent for // the specified period. AudioSilenceSettings *AudioSilenceFailoverSettings // MediaLive will perform a failover if content is not detected in this input for // the specified period. InputLossSettings *InputLossFailoverSettings // MediaLive will perform a failover if content is considered black for the // specified period. VideoBlackSettings *VideoBlackFailoverSettings }
Settings for one failover condition.
type FeatureActivations ¶
type FeatureActivations struct { // Enables the Input Prepare feature. You can create Input Prepare actions in the // schedule only if this feature is enabled. If you disable the feature on an // existing schedule, make sure that you first delete all input prepare actions // from the schedule. InputPrepareScheduleActions FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions }
Feature Activations
type FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions ¶
type FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions string
const ( FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActionsDisabled FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions = "DISABLED" FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActionsEnabled FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions
func (FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions) Values() []FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions
Values returns all known values for FeatureActivationsInputPrepareScheduleActions. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type FecOutputIncludeFec ¶
type FecOutputIncludeFec string
const ( FecOutputIncludeFecColumn FecOutputIncludeFec = "COLUMN" FecOutputIncludeFecColumnAndRow FecOutputIncludeFec = "COLUMN_AND_ROW" )
Enum values for FecOutputIncludeFec
func (FecOutputIncludeFec) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (FecOutputIncludeFec) Values() []FecOutputIncludeFec
Values returns all known values for FecOutputIncludeFec. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type FecOutputSettings ¶
type FecOutputSettings struct { // Parameter D from SMPTE 2022-1. The height of the FEC protection matrix. The // number of transport stream packets per column error correction packet. Must be // between 4 and 20, inclusive. ColumnDepth int32 // Enables column only or column and row based FEC IncludeFec FecOutputIncludeFec // Parameter L from SMPTE 2022-1. The width of the FEC protection matrix. Must be // between 1 and 20, inclusive. If only Column FEC is used, then larger values // increase robustness. If Row FEC is used, then this is the number of transport // stream packets per row error correction packet, and the value must be between 4 // and 20, inclusive, if includeFec is columnAndRow. If includeFec is column, this // value must be 1 to 20, inclusive. RowLength int32 }
Fec Output Settings
type FixedAfd ¶
type FixedAfd string
const ( FixedAfdAfd0000 FixedAfd = "AFD_0000" FixedAfdAfd0010 FixedAfd = "AFD_0010" FixedAfdAfd0011 FixedAfd = "AFD_0011" FixedAfdAfd0100 FixedAfd = "AFD_0100" FixedAfdAfd1000 FixedAfd = "AFD_1000" FixedAfdAfd1001 FixedAfd = "AFD_1001" FixedAfdAfd1010 FixedAfd = "AFD_1010" FixedAfdAfd1011 FixedAfd = "AFD_1011" FixedAfdAfd1101 FixedAfd = "AFD_1101" FixedAfdAfd1110 FixedAfd = "AFD_1110" FixedAfdAfd1111 FixedAfd = "AFD_1111" )
Enum values for FixedAfd
type FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings ¶
type FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings struct { // Start time for the action to start in the channel. (Not the time for the action // to be added to the schedule: actions are always added to the schedule // immediately.) UTC format: yyyy-mm-ddThh:mm:ss.nnnZ. All the letters are digits // (for example, mm might be 01) except for the two constants "T" for time and "Z" // for "UTC format". // // This member is required. Time *string }
Start time for the action.
type Fmp4HlsSettings ¶
type Fmp4HlsSettings struct { // List all the audio groups that are used with the video output stream. Input all // the audio GROUP-IDs that are associated to the video, separate by ','. AudioRenditionSets *string // If set to passthrough, Nielsen inaudible tones for media tracking will be // detected in the input audio and an equivalent ID3 tag will be inserted in the // output. NielsenId3Behavior Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior // When set to passthrough, timed metadata is passed through from input to output. TimedMetadataBehavior Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior }
Fmp4 Hls Settings
type Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior ¶
type Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior string
const ( Fmp4NielsenId3BehaviorNoPassthrough Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" Fmp4NielsenId3BehaviorPassthrough Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior
func (Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior) Values() []Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior
Values returns all known values for Fmp4NielsenId3Behavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior ¶
type Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior string
const ( Fmp4TimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" Fmp4TimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior
func (Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior) Values() []Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior
Values returns all known values for Fmp4TimedMetadataBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings ¶
type FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings struct { // Identifies whether this action starts relative to the start or relative to the // end of the reference action. // // This member is required. FollowPoint FollowPoint // The action name of another action that this one refers to. // // This member is required. ReferenceActionName *string }
Settings to specify if an action follows another.
type FollowPoint ¶
type FollowPoint string
const ( FollowPointEnd FollowPoint = "END" FollowPointStart FollowPoint = "START" )
Enum values for FollowPoint
func (FollowPoint) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (FollowPoint) Values() []FollowPoint
Values returns all known values for FollowPoint. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ForbiddenException ¶
type ForbiddenException struct {
Message *string
}
Placeholder documentation for ForbiddenException
func (*ForbiddenException) Error ¶
func (e *ForbiddenException) Error() string
func (*ForbiddenException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *ForbiddenException) ErrorCode() string
func (*ForbiddenException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *ForbiddenException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*ForbiddenException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *ForbiddenException) ErrorMessage() string
type FrameCaptureCdnSettings ¶ added in v1.2.0
type FrameCaptureCdnSettings struct { // Frame Capture S3 Settings FrameCaptureS3Settings *FrameCaptureS3Settings }
Frame Capture Cdn Settings
type FrameCaptureGroupSettings ¶
type FrameCaptureGroupSettings struct { // The destination for the frame capture files. Either the URI for an Amazon S3 // bucket and object, plus a file name prefix (for example, // s3ssl://sportsDelivery/highlights/20180820/curling-) or the URI for a MediaStore // container, plus a file name prefix (for example, // mediastoressl://sportsDelivery/20180820/curling-). The final file names consist // of the prefix from the destination field (for example, "curling-") + name // modifier + the counter (5 digits, starting from 00001) + extension (which is // always .jpg). For example, curling-low.00001.jpg // // This member is required. Destination *OutputLocationRef // Parameters that control interactions with the CDN. FrameCaptureCdnSettings *FrameCaptureCdnSettings }
Frame Capture Group Settings
type FrameCaptureHlsSettings ¶ added in v1.2.0
type FrameCaptureHlsSettings struct { }
Frame Capture Hls Settings
type FrameCaptureIntervalUnit ¶
type FrameCaptureIntervalUnit string
const ( FrameCaptureIntervalUnitMilliseconds FrameCaptureIntervalUnit = "MILLISECONDS" FrameCaptureIntervalUnitSeconds FrameCaptureIntervalUnit = "SECONDS" )
Enum values for FrameCaptureIntervalUnit
func (FrameCaptureIntervalUnit) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (FrameCaptureIntervalUnit) Values() []FrameCaptureIntervalUnit
Values returns all known values for FrameCaptureIntervalUnit. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type FrameCaptureOutputSettings ¶
type FrameCaptureOutputSettings struct { // Required if the output group contains more than one output. This modifier forms // part of the output file name. NameModifier *string }
Frame Capture Output Settings
type FrameCaptureS3Settings ¶ added in v1.2.0
type FrameCaptureS3Settings struct { // Specify the canned ACL to apply to each S3 request. Defaults to none. CannedAcl S3CannedAcl }
Frame Capture S3 Settings
type FrameCaptureSettings ¶
type FrameCaptureSettings struct { // The frequency at which to capture frames for inclusion in the output. May be // specified in either seconds or milliseconds, as specified by // captureIntervalUnits. CaptureInterval int32 // Unit for the frame capture interval. CaptureIntervalUnits FrameCaptureIntervalUnit }
Frame Capture Settings
type GatewayTimeoutException ¶
type GatewayTimeoutException struct {
Message *string
}
Placeholder documentation for GatewayTimeoutException
func (*GatewayTimeoutException) Error ¶
func (e *GatewayTimeoutException) Error() string
func (*GatewayTimeoutException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *GatewayTimeoutException) ErrorCode() string
func (*GatewayTimeoutException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *GatewayTimeoutException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*GatewayTimeoutException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *GatewayTimeoutException) ErrorMessage() string
type GlobalConfiguration ¶
type GlobalConfiguration struct { // Value to set the initial audio gain for the Live Event. InitialAudioGain int32 // Indicates the action to take when the current input completes (e.g. // end-of-file). When switchAndLoopInputs is configured the encoder will restart at // the beginning of the first input. When "none" is configured the encoder will // transcode either black, a solid color, or a user specified slate images per the // "Input Loss Behavior" configuration until the next input switch occurs (which is // controlled through the Channel Schedule API). InputEndAction GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction // Settings for system actions when input is lost. InputLossBehavior *InputLossBehavior // Indicates how MediaLive pipelines are synchronized. PIPELINE_LOCKING - MediaLive // will attempt to synchronize the output of each pipeline to the other. // EPOCH_LOCKING - MediaLive will attempt to synchronize the output of each // pipeline to the Unix epoch. OutputLockingMode GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode // Indicates whether the rate of frames emitted by the Live encoder should be paced // by its system clock (which optionally may be locked to another source via NTP) // or should be locked to the clock of the source that is providing the input // stream. OutputTimingSource GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource // Adjusts video input buffer for streams with very low video framerates. This is // commonly set to enabled for music channels with less than one video frame per // second. SupportLowFramerateInputs GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs }
Global Configuration
type GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction ¶
type GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction string
const ( GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionNone GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction = "NONE" GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionSwitchAndLoopInputs GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction = "SWITCH_AND_LOOP_INPUTS" )
Enum values for GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction
func (GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction) Values() []GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction
Values returns all known values for GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs ¶
type GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs string
const ( GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsDisabled GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs = "DISABLED" GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsEnabled GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs
func (GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs) Values() []GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs
Values returns all known values for GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode ¶
type GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode string
const ( GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingModeEpochLocking GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode = "EPOCH_LOCKING" GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingModePipelineLocking GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode = "PIPELINE_LOCKING" )
Enum values for GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode
func (GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode) Values() []GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode
Values returns all known values for GlobalConfigurationOutputLockingMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource ¶
type GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource string
const ( GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceInputClock GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource = "INPUT_CLOCK" GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceSystemClock GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource = "SYSTEM_CLOCK" )
Enum values for GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource
func (GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource) Values() []GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource
Values returns all known values for GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264AdaptiveQuantization ¶
type H264AdaptiveQuantization string
const ( H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigh H264AdaptiveQuantization = "HIGH" H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigher H264AdaptiveQuantization = "HIGHER" H264AdaptiveQuantizationLow H264AdaptiveQuantization = "LOW" H264AdaptiveQuantizationMax H264AdaptiveQuantization = "MAX" H264AdaptiveQuantizationMedium H264AdaptiveQuantization = "MEDIUM" H264AdaptiveQuantizationOff H264AdaptiveQuantization = "OFF" )
Enum values for H264AdaptiveQuantization
func (H264AdaptiveQuantization) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264AdaptiveQuantization) Values() []H264AdaptiveQuantization
Values returns all known values for H264AdaptiveQuantization. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264ColorMetadata ¶
type H264ColorMetadata string
const ( H264ColorMetadataIgnore H264ColorMetadata = "IGNORE" H264ColorMetadataInsert H264ColorMetadata = "INSERT" )
Enum values for H264ColorMetadata
func (H264ColorMetadata) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264ColorMetadata) Values() []H264ColorMetadata
Values returns all known values for H264ColorMetadata. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264ColorSpaceSettings ¶
type H264ColorSpaceSettings struct { // Passthrough applies no color space conversion to the output ColorSpacePassthroughSettings *ColorSpacePassthroughSettings // Rec601 Settings Rec601Settings *Rec601Settings // Rec709 Settings Rec709Settings *Rec709Settings }
H264 Color Space Settings
type H264EntropyEncoding ¶
type H264EntropyEncoding string
const ( H264EntropyEncodingCabac H264EntropyEncoding = "CABAC" H264EntropyEncodingCavlc H264EntropyEncoding = "CAVLC" )
Enum values for H264EntropyEncoding
func (H264EntropyEncoding) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264EntropyEncoding) Values() []H264EntropyEncoding
Values returns all known values for H264EntropyEncoding. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264FilterSettings ¶
type H264FilterSettings struct { // Temporal Filter Settings TemporalFilterSettings *TemporalFilterSettings }
H264 Filter Settings
type H264FlickerAq ¶
type H264FlickerAq string
const ( H264FlickerAqDisabled H264FlickerAq = "DISABLED" H264FlickerAqEnabled H264FlickerAq = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for H264FlickerAq
func (H264FlickerAq) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264FlickerAq) Values() []H264FlickerAq
Values returns all known values for H264FlickerAq. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264ForceFieldPictures ¶
type H264ForceFieldPictures string
const ( H264ForceFieldPicturesDisabled H264ForceFieldPictures = "DISABLED" H264ForceFieldPicturesEnabled H264ForceFieldPictures = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for H264ForceFieldPictures
func (H264ForceFieldPictures) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264ForceFieldPictures) Values() []H264ForceFieldPictures
Values returns all known values for H264ForceFieldPictures. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264FramerateControl ¶
type H264FramerateControl string
const ( H264FramerateControlInitializeFromSource H264FramerateControl = "INITIALIZE_FROM_SOURCE" H264FramerateControlSpecified H264FramerateControl = "SPECIFIED" )
Enum values for H264FramerateControl
func (H264FramerateControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264FramerateControl) Values() []H264FramerateControl
Values returns all known values for H264FramerateControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264GopBReference ¶
type H264GopBReference string
const ( H264GopBReferenceDisabled H264GopBReference = "DISABLED" H264GopBReferenceEnabled H264GopBReference = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for H264GopBReference
func (H264GopBReference) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264GopBReference) Values() []H264GopBReference
Values returns all known values for H264GopBReference. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264GopSizeUnits ¶
type H264GopSizeUnits string
const ( H264GopSizeUnitsFrames H264GopSizeUnits = "FRAMES" H264GopSizeUnitsSeconds H264GopSizeUnits = "SECONDS" )
Enum values for H264GopSizeUnits
func (H264GopSizeUnits) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264GopSizeUnits) Values() []H264GopSizeUnits
Values returns all known values for H264GopSizeUnits. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264Level ¶
type H264Level string
const ( H264LevelH264Level1 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_1" H264LevelH264Level11 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_1_1" H264LevelH264Level12 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_1_2" H264LevelH264Level13 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_1_3" H264LevelH264Level2 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_2" H264LevelH264Level21 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_2_1" H264LevelH264Level22 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_2_2" H264LevelH264Level3 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_3" H264LevelH264Level31 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_3_1" H264LevelH264Level32 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_3_2" H264LevelH264Level4 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_4" H264LevelH264Level41 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_4_1" H264LevelH264Level42 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_4_2" H264LevelH264Level5 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_5" H264LevelH264Level51 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_5_1" H264LevelH264Level52 H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_5_2" H264LevelH264LevelAuto H264Level = "H264_LEVEL_AUTO" )
Enum values for H264Level
type H264LookAheadRateControl ¶
type H264LookAheadRateControl string
const ( H264LookAheadRateControlHigh H264LookAheadRateControl = "HIGH" H264LookAheadRateControlLow H264LookAheadRateControl = "LOW" H264LookAheadRateControlMedium H264LookAheadRateControl = "MEDIUM" )
Enum values for H264LookAheadRateControl
func (H264LookAheadRateControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264LookAheadRateControl) Values() []H264LookAheadRateControl
Values returns all known values for H264LookAheadRateControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264ParControl ¶
type H264ParControl string
const ( H264ParControlInitializeFromSource H264ParControl = "INITIALIZE_FROM_SOURCE" H264ParControlSpecified H264ParControl = "SPECIFIED" )
Enum values for H264ParControl
func (H264ParControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264ParControl) Values() []H264ParControl
Values returns all known values for H264ParControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264Profile ¶
type H264Profile string
const ( H264ProfileBaseline H264Profile = "BASELINE" H264ProfileHigh H264Profile = "HIGH" H264ProfileHigh10bit H264Profile = "HIGH_10BIT" H264ProfileHigh422 H264Profile = "HIGH_422" H264ProfileHigh42210bit H264Profile = "HIGH_422_10BIT" H264ProfileMain H264Profile = "MAIN" )
Enum values for H264Profile
func (H264Profile) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264Profile) Values() []H264Profile
Values returns all known values for H264Profile. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264QualityLevel ¶
type H264QualityLevel string
const ( H264QualityLevelEnhancedQuality H264QualityLevel = "ENHANCED_QUALITY" H264QualityLevelStandardQuality H264QualityLevel = "STANDARD_QUALITY" )
Enum values for H264QualityLevel
func (H264QualityLevel) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264QualityLevel) Values() []H264QualityLevel
Values returns all known values for H264QualityLevel. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264RateControlMode ¶
type H264RateControlMode string
const ( H264RateControlModeCbr H264RateControlMode = "CBR" H264RateControlModeMultiplex H264RateControlMode = "MULTIPLEX" H264RateControlModeQvbr H264RateControlMode = "QVBR" H264RateControlModeVbr H264RateControlMode = "VBR" )
Enum values for H264RateControlMode
func (H264RateControlMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264RateControlMode) Values() []H264RateControlMode
Values returns all known values for H264RateControlMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264ScanType ¶
type H264ScanType string
const ( H264ScanTypeInterlaced H264ScanType = "INTERLACED" H264ScanTypeProgressive H264ScanType = "PROGRESSIVE" )
Enum values for H264ScanType
func (H264ScanType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264ScanType) Values() []H264ScanType
Values returns all known values for H264ScanType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264SceneChangeDetect ¶
type H264SceneChangeDetect string
const ( H264SceneChangeDetectDisabled H264SceneChangeDetect = "DISABLED" H264SceneChangeDetectEnabled H264SceneChangeDetect = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for H264SceneChangeDetect
func (H264SceneChangeDetect) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264SceneChangeDetect) Values() []H264SceneChangeDetect
Values returns all known values for H264SceneChangeDetect. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264Settings ¶
type H264Settings struct { // Adaptive quantization. Allows intra-frame quantizers to vary to improve visual // quality. AdaptiveQuantization H264AdaptiveQuantization // Indicates that AFD values will be written into the output stream. If // afdSignaling is "auto", the system will try to preserve the input AFD value (in // cases where multiple AFD values are valid). If set to "fixed", the AFD value // will be the value configured in the fixedAfd parameter. AfdSignaling AfdSignaling // Average bitrate in bits/second. Required when the rate control mode is VBR or // CBR. Not used for QVBR. In an MS Smooth output group, each output must have a // unique value when its bitrate is rounded down to the nearest multiple of 1000. Bitrate int32 // Percentage of the buffer that should initially be filled (HRD buffer model). BufFillPct int32 // Size of buffer (HRD buffer model) in bits. BufSize int32 // Includes colorspace metadata in the output. ColorMetadata H264ColorMetadata // Color Space settings ColorSpaceSettings *H264ColorSpaceSettings // Entropy encoding mode. Use cabac (must be in Main or High profile) or cavlc. EntropyEncoding H264EntropyEncoding // Optional filters that you can apply to an encode. FilterSettings *H264FilterSettings // Four bit AFD value to write on all frames of video in the output stream. Only // valid when afdSignaling is set to 'Fixed'. FixedAfd FixedAfd // If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame to reduce flicker or // 'pop' on I-frames. FlickerAq H264FlickerAq // This setting applies only when scan type is "interlaced." It controls whether // coding is performed on a field basis or on a frame basis. (When the video is // progressive, the coding is always performed on a frame basis.) enabled: Force // MediaLive to code on a field basis, so that odd and even sets of fields are // coded separately. disabled: Code the two sets of fields separately (on a field // basis) or together (on a frame basis using PAFF), depending on what is most // appropriate for the content. ForceFieldPictures H264ForceFieldPictures // This field indicates how the output video frame rate is specified. If // "specified" is selected then the output video frame rate is determined by // framerateNumerator and framerateDenominator, else if "initializeFromSource" is // selected then the output video frame rate will be set equal to the input video // frame rate of the first input. FramerateControl H264FramerateControl // Framerate denominator. FramerateDenominator int32 // Framerate numerator - framerate is a fraction, e.g. 24000 / 1001 = 23.976 fps. FramerateNumerator int32 // Documentation update needed GopBReference H264GopBReference // Frequency of closed GOPs. In streaming applications, it is recommended that this // be set to 1 so a decoder joining mid-stream will receive an IDR frame as quickly // as possible. Setting this value to 0 will break output segmenting. GopClosedCadence int32 // Number of B-frames between reference frames. GopNumBFrames int32 // GOP size (keyframe interval) in units of either frames or seconds per // gopSizeUnits. If gopSizeUnits is frames, gopSize must be an integer and must be // greater than or equal to 1. If gopSizeUnits is seconds, gopSize must be greater // than 0, but need not be an integer. GopSize float64 // Indicates if the gopSize is specified in frames or seconds. If seconds the // system will convert the gopSize into a frame count at run time. GopSizeUnits H264GopSizeUnits // H.264 Level. Level H264Level // Amount of lookahead. A value of low can decrease latency and memory usage, while // high can produce better quality for certain content. LookAheadRateControl H264LookAheadRateControl // For QVBR: See the tooltip for Quality level For VBR: Set the maximum bitrate in // order to accommodate expected spikes in the complexity of the video. MaxBitrate int32 // Only meaningful if sceneChangeDetect is set to enabled. Defaults to 5 if // multiplex rate control is used. Enforces separation between repeated (cadence) // I-frames and I-frames inserted by Scene Change Detection. If a scene change // I-frame is within I-interval frames of a cadence I-frame, the GOP is shrunk // and/or stretched to the scene change I-frame. GOP stretch requires enabling // lookahead as well as setting I-interval. The normal cadence resumes for the next // GOP. Note: Maximum GOP stretch = GOP size + Min-I-interval - 1 MinIInterval int32 // Number of reference frames to use. The encoder may use more than requested if // using B-frames and/or interlaced encoding. NumRefFrames int32 // This field indicates how the output pixel aspect ratio is specified. If // "specified" is selected then the output video pixel aspect ratio is determined // by parNumerator and parDenominator, else if "initializeFromSource" is selected // then the output pixsel aspect ratio will be set equal to the input video pixel // aspect ratio of the first input. ParControl H264ParControl // Pixel Aspect Ratio denominator. ParDenominator int32 // Pixel Aspect Ratio numerator. ParNumerator int32 // H.264 Profile. Profile H264Profile // Leave as STANDARD_QUALITY or choose a different value (which might result in // additional costs to run the channel). // // * ENHANCED_QUALITY: Produces a slightly // better video quality without an increase in the bitrate. Has an effect only when // the Rate control mode is QVBR or CBR. If this channel is in a MediaLive // multiplex, the value must be ENHANCED_QUALITY. // // * STANDARD_QUALITY: Valid for // any Rate control mode. QualityLevel H264QualityLevel // Controls the target quality for the video encode. Applies only when the rate // control mode is QVBR. Set values for the QVBR quality level field and Max // bitrate field that suit your most important viewing devices. Recommended values // are: // // * Primary screen: Quality level: 8 to 10. Max bitrate: 4M // // * PC or tablet: // Quality level: 7. Max bitrate: 1.5M to 3M // // * Smartphone: Quality level: 6. Max // bitrate: 1M to 1.5M QvbrQualityLevel int32 // Rate control mode. QVBR: Quality will match the specified quality level except // when it is constrained by the maximum bitrate. Recommended if you or your // viewers pay for bandwidth. VBR: Quality and bitrate vary, depending on the video // complexity. Recommended instead of QVBR if you want to maintain a specific // average bitrate over the duration of the channel. CBR: Quality varies, depending // on the video complexity. Recommended only if you distribute your assets to // devices that cannot handle variable bitrates. Multiplex: This rate control mode // is only supported (and is required) when the video is being delivered to a // MediaLive Multiplex in which case the rate control configuration is controlled // by the properties within the Multiplex Program. RateControlMode H264RateControlMode // Sets the scan type of the output to progressive or top-field-first interlaced. ScanType H264ScanType // Scene change detection. // // * On: inserts I-frames when scene change is // detected. // // * Off: does not force an I-frame when scene change is detected. SceneChangeDetect H264SceneChangeDetect // Number of slices per picture. Must be less than or equal to the number of // macroblock rows for progressive pictures, and less than or equal to half the // number of macroblock rows for interlaced pictures. This field is optional; when // no value is specified the encoder will choose the number of slices based on // encode resolution. Slices int32 // Softness. Selects quantizer matrix, larger values reduce high-frequency content // in the encoded image. If not set to zero, must be greater than 15. Softness int32 // If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame based on spatial // variation of content complexity. SpatialAq H264SpatialAq // If set to fixed, use gopNumBFrames B-frames per sub-GOP. If set to dynamic, // optimize the number of B-frames used for each sub-GOP to improve visual quality. SubgopLength H264SubGopLength // Produces a bitstream compliant with SMPTE RP-2027. Syntax H264Syntax // If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame based on temporal // variation of content complexity. TemporalAq H264TemporalAq // Determines how timecodes should be inserted into the video elementary stream. // // * // 'disabled': Do not include timecodes // // * 'picTimingSei': Pass through picture // timing SEI messages from the source specified in Timecode Config TimecodeInsertion H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior }
H264 Settings
type H264SpatialAq ¶
type H264SpatialAq string
const ( H264SpatialAqDisabled H264SpatialAq = "DISABLED" H264SpatialAqEnabled H264SpatialAq = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for H264SpatialAq
func (H264SpatialAq) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264SpatialAq) Values() []H264SpatialAq
Values returns all known values for H264SpatialAq. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264SubGopLength ¶
type H264SubGopLength string
const ( H264SubGopLengthDynamic H264SubGopLength = "DYNAMIC" H264SubGopLengthFixed H264SubGopLength = "FIXED" )
Enum values for H264SubGopLength
func (H264SubGopLength) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264SubGopLength) Values() []H264SubGopLength
Values returns all known values for H264SubGopLength. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264Syntax ¶
type H264Syntax string
const ( H264SyntaxDefault H264Syntax = "DEFAULT" H264SyntaxRp2027 H264Syntax = "RP2027" )
Enum values for H264Syntax
func (H264Syntax) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264Syntax) Values() []H264Syntax
Values returns all known values for H264Syntax. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264TemporalAq ¶
type H264TemporalAq string
const ( H264TemporalAqDisabled H264TemporalAq = "DISABLED" H264TemporalAqEnabled H264TemporalAq = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for H264TemporalAq
func (H264TemporalAq) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264TemporalAq) Values() []H264TemporalAq
Values returns all known values for H264TemporalAq. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior ¶
type H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior string
const ( H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorDisabled H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior = "DISABLED" H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorPicTimingSei H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior = "PIC_TIMING_SEI" )
Enum values for H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior
func (H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior) Values() []H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior
Values returns all known values for H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265AdaptiveQuantization ¶
type H265AdaptiveQuantization string
const ( H265AdaptiveQuantizationHigh H265AdaptiveQuantization = "HIGH" H265AdaptiveQuantizationHigher H265AdaptiveQuantization = "HIGHER" H265AdaptiveQuantizationLow H265AdaptiveQuantization = "LOW" H265AdaptiveQuantizationMax H265AdaptiveQuantization = "MAX" H265AdaptiveQuantizationMedium H265AdaptiveQuantization = "MEDIUM" H265AdaptiveQuantizationOff H265AdaptiveQuantization = "OFF" )
Enum values for H265AdaptiveQuantization
func (H265AdaptiveQuantization) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265AdaptiveQuantization) Values() []H265AdaptiveQuantization
Values returns all known values for H265AdaptiveQuantization. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265AlternativeTransferFunction ¶
type H265AlternativeTransferFunction string
const ( H265AlternativeTransferFunctionInsert H265AlternativeTransferFunction = "INSERT" H265AlternativeTransferFunctionOmit H265AlternativeTransferFunction = "OMIT" )
Enum values for H265AlternativeTransferFunction
func (H265AlternativeTransferFunction) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265AlternativeTransferFunction) Values() []H265AlternativeTransferFunction
Values returns all known values for H265AlternativeTransferFunction. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265ColorMetadata ¶
type H265ColorMetadata string
const ( H265ColorMetadataIgnore H265ColorMetadata = "IGNORE" H265ColorMetadataInsert H265ColorMetadata = "INSERT" )
Enum values for H265ColorMetadata
func (H265ColorMetadata) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265ColorMetadata) Values() []H265ColorMetadata
Values returns all known values for H265ColorMetadata. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265ColorSpaceSettings ¶
type H265ColorSpaceSettings struct { // Passthrough applies no color space conversion to the output ColorSpacePassthroughSettings *ColorSpacePassthroughSettings // Hdr10 Settings Hdr10Settings *Hdr10Settings // Rec601 Settings Rec601Settings *Rec601Settings // Rec709 Settings Rec709Settings *Rec709Settings }
H265 Color Space Settings
type H265FilterSettings ¶
type H265FilterSettings struct { // Temporal Filter Settings TemporalFilterSettings *TemporalFilterSettings }
H265 Filter Settings
type H265FlickerAq ¶
type H265FlickerAq string
const ( H265FlickerAqDisabled H265FlickerAq = "DISABLED" H265FlickerAqEnabled H265FlickerAq = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for H265FlickerAq
func (H265FlickerAq) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265FlickerAq) Values() []H265FlickerAq
Values returns all known values for H265FlickerAq. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265GopSizeUnits ¶
type H265GopSizeUnits string
const ( H265GopSizeUnitsFrames H265GopSizeUnits = "FRAMES" H265GopSizeUnitsSeconds H265GopSizeUnits = "SECONDS" )
Enum values for H265GopSizeUnits
func (H265GopSizeUnits) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265GopSizeUnits) Values() []H265GopSizeUnits
Values returns all known values for H265GopSizeUnits. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265Level ¶
type H265Level string
const ( H265LevelH265Level1 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_1" H265LevelH265Level2 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_2" H265LevelH265Level21 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_2_1" H265LevelH265Level3 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_3" H265LevelH265Level31 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_3_1" H265LevelH265Level4 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_4" H265LevelH265Level41 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_4_1" H265LevelH265Level5 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_5" H265LevelH265Level51 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_5_1" H265LevelH265Level52 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_5_2" H265LevelH265Level6 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_6" H265LevelH265Level61 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_6_1" H265LevelH265Level62 H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_6_2" H265LevelH265LevelAuto H265Level = "H265_LEVEL_AUTO" )
Enum values for H265Level
type H265LookAheadRateControl ¶
type H265LookAheadRateControl string
const ( H265LookAheadRateControlHigh H265LookAheadRateControl = "HIGH" H265LookAheadRateControlLow H265LookAheadRateControl = "LOW" H265LookAheadRateControlMedium H265LookAheadRateControl = "MEDIUM" )
Enum values for H265LookAheadRateControl
func (H265LookAheadRateControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265LookAheadRateControl) Values() []H265LookAheadRateControl
Values returns all known values for H265LookAheadRateControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265Profile ¶
type H265Profile string
const ( H265ProfileMain H265Profile = "MAIN" H265ProfileMain10bit H265Profile = "MAIN_10BIT" )
Enum values for H265Profile
func (H265Profile) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265Profile) Values() []H265Profile
Values returns all known values for H265Profile. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265RateControlMode ¶
type H265RateControlMode string
const ( H265RateControlModeCbr H265RateControlMode = "CBR" H265RateControlModeMultiplex H265RateControlMode = "MULTIPLEX" H265RateControlModeQvbr H265RateControlMode = "QVBR" )
Enum values for H265RateControlMode
func (H265RateControlMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265RateControlMode) Values() []H265RateControlMode
Values returns all known values for H265RateControlMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265ScanType ¶
type H265ScanType string
const ( H265ScanTypeInterlaced H265ScanType = "INTERLACED" H265ScanTypeProgressive H265ScanType = "PROGRESSIVE" )
Enum values for H265ScanType
func (H265ScanType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265ScanType) Values() []H265ScanType
Values returns all known values for H265ScanType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265SceneChangeDetect ¶
type H265SceneChangeDetect string
const ( H265SceneChangeDetectDisabled H265SceneChangeDetect = "DISABLED" H265SceneChangeDetectEnabled H265SceneChangeDetect = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for H265SceneChangeDetect
func (H265SceneChangeDetect) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265SceneChangeDetect) Values() []H265SceneChangeDetect
Values returns all known values for H265SceneChangeDetect. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type H265Settings ¶
type H265Settings struct { // Framerate denominator. // // This member is required. FramerateDenominator int32 // Framerate numerator - framerate is a fraction, e.g. 24000 / 1001 = 23.976 fps. // // This member is required. FramerateNumerator int32 // Adaptive quantization. Allows intra-frame quantizers to vary to improve visual // quality. AdaptiveQuantization H265AdaptiveQuantization // Indicates that AFD values will be written into the output stream. If // afdSignaling is "auto", the system will try to preserve the input AFD value (in // cases where multiple AFD values are valid). If set to "fixed", the AFD value // will be the value configured in the fixedAfd parameter. AfdSignaling AfdSignaling // Whether or not EML should insert an Alternative Transfer Function SEI message to // support backwards compatibility with non-HDR decoders and displays. AlternativeTransferFunction H265AlternativeTransferFunction // Average bitrate in bits/second. Required when the rate control mode is VBR or // CBR. Not used for QVBR. In an MS Smooth output group, each output must have a // unique value when its bitrate is rounded down to the nearest multiple of 1000. Bitrate int32 // Size of buffer (HRD buffer model) in bits. BufSize int32 // Includes colorspace metadata in the output. ColorMetadata H265ColorMetadata // Color Space settings ColorSpaceSettings *H265ColorSpaceSettings // Optional filters that you can apply to an encode. FilterSettings *H265FilterSettings // Four bit AFD value to write on all frames of video in the output stream. Only // valid when afdSignaling is set to 'Fixed'. FixedAfd FixedAfd // If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame to reduce flicker or // 'pop' on I-frames. FlickerAq H265FlickerAq // Frequency of closed GOPs. In streaming applications, it is recommended that this // be set to 1 so a decoder joining mid-stream will receive an IDR frame as quickly // as possible. Setting this value to 0 will break output segmenting. GopClosedCadence int32 // GOP size (keyframe interval) in units of either frames or seconds per // gopSizeUnits. If gopSizeUnits is frames, gopSize must be an integer and must be // greater than or equal to 1. If gopSizeUnits is seconds, gopSize must be greater // than 0, but need not be an integer. GopSize float64 // Indicates if the gopSize is specified in frames or seconds. If seconds the // system will convert the gopSize into a frame count at run time. GopSizeUnits H265GopSizeUnits // H.265 Level. Level H265Level // Amount of lookahead. A value of low can decrease latency and memory usage, while // high can produce better quality for certain content. LookAheadRateControl H265LookAheadRateControl // For QVBR: See the tooltip for Quality level MaxBitrate int32 // Only meaningful if sceneChangeDetect is set to enabled. Defaults to 5 if // multiplex rate control is used. Enforces separation between repeated (cadence) // I-frames and I-frames inserted by Scene Change Detection. If a scene change // I-frame is within I-interval frames of a cadence I-frame, the GOP is shrunk // and/or stretched to the scene change I-frame. GOP stretch requires enabling // lookahead as well as setting I-interval. The normal cadence resumes for the next // GOP. Note: Maximum GOP stretch = GOP size + Min-I-interval - 1 MinIInterval int32 // Pixel Aspect Ratio denominator. ParDenominator int32 // Pixel Aspect Ratio numerator. ParNumerator int32 // H.265 Profile. Profile H265Profile // Controls the target quality for the video encode. Applies only when the rate // control mode is QVBR. Set values for the QVBR quality level field and Max // bitrate field that suit your most important viewing devices. Recommended values // are: // // * Primary screen: Quality level: 8 to 10. Max bitrate: 4M // // * PC or tablet: // Quality level: 7. Max bitrate: 1.5M to 3M // // * Smartphone: Quality level: 6. Max // bitrate: 1M to 1.5M QvbrQualityLevel int32 // Rate control mode. QVBR: Quality will match the specified quality level except // when it is constrained by the maximum bitrate. Recommended if you or your // viewers pay for bandwidth. CBR: Quality varies, depending on the video // complexity. Recommended only if you distribute your assets to devices that // cannot handle variable bitrates. Multiplex: This rate control mode is only // supported (and is required) when the video is being delivered to a MediaLive // Multiplex in which case the rate control configuration is controlled by the // properties within the Multiplex Program. RateControlMode H265RateControlMode // Sets the scan type of the output to progressive or top-field-first interlaced. ScanType H265ScanType // Scene change detection. SceneChangeDetect H265SceneChangeDetect // Number of slices per picture. Must be less than or equal to the number of // macroblock rows for progressive pictures, and less than or equal to half the // number of macroblock rows for interlaced pictures. This field is optional; when // no value is specified the encoder will choose the number of slices based on // encode resolution. Slices int32 // H.265 Tier. Tier H265Tier // Determines how timecodes should be inserted into the video elementary stream. // // * // 'disabled': Do not include timecodes // // * 'picTimingSei': Pass through picture // timing SEI messages from the source specified in Timecode Config TimecodeInsertion H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior }
H265 Settings
type H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior ¶
type H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior string
const ( H265TimecodeInsertionBehaviorDisabled H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior = "DISABLED" H265TimecodeInsertionBehaviorPicTimingSei H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior = "PIC_TIMING_SEI" )
Enum values for H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior
func (H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior) Values() []H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior
Values returns all known values for H265TimecodeInsertionBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Hdr10Settings ¶
type Hdr10Settings struct { // Maximum Content Light Level An integer metadata value defining the maximum light // level, in nits, of any single pixel within an encoded HDR video stream or file. MaxCll int32 // Maximum Frame Average Light Level An integer metadata value defining the maximum // average light level, in nits, for any single frame within an encoded HDR video // stream or file. MaxFall int32 }
Hdr10 Settings
type HlsAdMarkers ¶
type HlsAdMarkers string
const ( HlsAdMarkersAdobe HlsAdMarkers = "ADOBE" HlsAdMarkersElemental HlsAdMarkers = "ELEMENTAL" HlsAdMarkersElementalScte35 HlsAdMarkers = "ELEMENTAL_SCTE35" )
Enum values for HlsAdMarkers
func (HlsAdMarkers) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsAdMarkers) Values() []HlsAdMarkers
Values returns all known values for HlsAdMarkers. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode ¶
type HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode string
const ( HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeChunked HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode = "CHUNKED" HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeNonChunked HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode = "NON_CHUNKED" )
Enum values for HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode
func (HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode) Values() []HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode
Values returns all known values for HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsAkamaiSettings ¶
type HlsAkamaiSettings struct { // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the // connection is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval int32 // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration int32 // Specify whether or not to use chunked transfer encoding to Akamai. User should // contact Akamai to enable this feature. HttpTransferMode HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode // Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into an // error state. NumRetries int32 // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay int32 // Salt for authenticated Akamai. Salt *string // Token parameter for authenticated akamai. If not specified, gda is used. Token *string }
Hls Akamai Settings
type HlsBasicPutSettings ¶
type HlsBasicPutSettings struct { // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the // connection is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval int32 // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration int32 // Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into an // error state. NumRetries int32 // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay int32 }
Hls Basic Put Settings
type HlsCaptionLanguageSetting ¶
type HlsCaptionLanguageSetting string
const ( HlsCaptionLanguageSettingInsert HlsCaptionLanguageSetting = "INSERT" HlsCaptionLanguageSettingNone HlsCaptionLanguageSetting = "NONE" HlsCaptionLanguageSettingOmit HlsCaptionLanguageSetting = "OMIT" )
Enum values for HlsCaptionLanguageSetting
func (HlsCaptionLanguageSetting) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsCaptionLanguageSetting) Values() []HlsCaptionLanguageSetting
Values returns all known values for HlsCaptionLanguageSetting. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsCdnSettings ¶
type HlsCdnSettings struct { // Hls Akamai Settings HlsAkamaiSettings *HlsAkamaiSettings // Hls Basic Put Settings HlsBasicPutSettings *HlsBasicPutSettings // Hls Media Store Settings HlsMediaStoreSettings *HlsMediaStoreSettings // Hls S3 Settings HlsS3Settings *HlsS3Settings // Hls Webdav Settings HlsWebdavSettings *HlsWebdavSettings }
Hls Cdn Settings
type HlsClientCache ¶
type HlsClientCache string
const ( HlsClientCacheDisabled HlsClientCache = "DISABLED" HlsClientCacheEnabled HlsClientCache = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for HlsClientCache
func (HlsClientCache) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsClientCache) Values() []HlsClientCache
Values returns all known values for HlsClientCache. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsCodecSpecification ¶
type HlsCodecSpecification string
const ( HlsCodecSpecificationRfc4281 HlsCodecSpecification = "RFC_4281" HlsCodecSpecificationRfc6381 HlsCodecSpecification = "RFC_6381" )
Enum values for HlsCodecSpecification
func (HlsCodecSpecification) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsCodecSpecification) Values() []HlsCodecSpecification
Values returns all known values for HlsCodecSpecification. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsDirectoryStructure ¶
type HlsDirectoryStructure string
const ( HlsDirectoryStructureSingleDirectory HlsDirectoryStructure = "SINGLE_DIRECTORY" HlsDirectoryStructureSubdirectoryPerStream HlsDirectoryStructure = "SUBDIRECTORY_PER_STREAM" )
Enum values for HlsDirectoryStructure
func (HlsDirectoryStructure) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsDirectoryStructure) Values() []HlsDirectoryStructure
Values returns all known values for HlsDirectoryStructure. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsDiscontinuityTags ¶ added in v0.29.0
type HlsDiscontinuityTags string
const ( HlsDiscontinuityTagsInsert HlsDiscontinuityTags = "INSERT" HlsDiscontinuityTagsNeverInsert HlsDiscontinuityTags = "NEVER_INSERT" )
Enum values for HlsDiscontinuityTags
func (HlsDiscontinuityTags) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsDiscontinuityTags) Values() []HlsDiscontinuityTags
Values returns all known values for HlsDiscontinuityTags. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsEncryptionType ¶
type HlsEncryptionType string
const ( HlsEncryptionTypeAes128 HlsEncryptionType = "AES128" HlsEncryptionTypeSampleAes HlsEncryptionType = "SAMPLE_AES" )
Enum values for HlsEncryptionType
func (HlsEncryptionType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsEncryptionType) Values() []HlsEncryptionType
Values returns all known values for HlsEncryptionType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsGroupSettings ¶
type HlsGroupSettings struct { // A directory or HTTP destination for the HLS segments, manifest files, and // encryption keys (if enabled). // // This member is required. Destination *OutputLocationRef // Choose one or more ad marker types to pass SCTE35 signals through to this group // of Apple HLS outputs. AdMarkers []HlsAdMarkers // A partial URI prefix that will be prepended to each output in the media .m3u8 // file. Can be used if base manifest is delivered from a different URL than the // main .m3u8 file. BaseUrlContent *string // Optional. One value per output group. This field is required only if you are // completing Base URL content A, and the downstream system has notified you that // the media files for pipeline 1 of all outputs are in a location different from // the media files for pipeline 0. BaseUrlContent1 *string // A partial URI prefix that will be prepended to each output in the media .m3u8 // file. Can be used if base manifest is delivered from a different URL than the // main .m3u8 file. BaseUrlManifest *string // Optional. One value per output group. Complete this field only if you are // completing Base URL manifest A, and the downstream system has notified you that // the child manifest files for pipeline 1 of all outputs are in a location // different from the child manifest files for pipeline 0. BaseUrlManifest1 *string // Mapping of up to 4 caption channels to caption languages. Is only meaningful if // captionLanguageSetting is set to "insert". CaptionLanguageMappings []CaptionLanguageMapping // Applies only to 608 Embedded output captions. insert: Include CLOSED-CAPTIONS // lines in the manifest. Specify at least one language in the CC1 Language Code // field. One CLOSED-CAPTION line is added for each Language Code you specify. Make // sure to specify the languages in the order in which they appear in the original // source (if the source is embedded format) or the order of the caption selectors // (if the source is other than embedded). Otherwise, languages in the manifest // will not match up properly with the output captions. none: Include // CLOSED-CAPTIONS=NONE line in the manifest. omit: Omit any CLOSED-CAPTIONS line // from the manifest. CaptionLanguageSetting HlsCaptionLanguageSetting // When set to "disabled", sets the #EXT-X-ALLOW-CACHE:no tag in the manifest, // which prevents clients from saving media segments for later replay. ClientCache HlsClientCache // Specification to use (RFC-6381 or the default RFC-4281) during m3u8 playlist // generation. CodecSpecification HlsCodecSpecification // For use with encryptionType. This is a 128-bit, 16-byte hex value represented by // a 32-character text string. If ivSource is set to "explicit" then this parameter // is required and is used as the IV for encryption. ConstantIv *string // Place segments in subdirectories. DirectoryStructure HlsDirectoryStructure // Specifies whether to insert EXT-X-DISCONTINUITY tags in the HLS child manifests // for this output group. Typically, choose Insert because these tags are required // in the manifest (according to the HLS specification) and serve an important // purpose. Choose Never Insert only if the downstream system is doing real-time // failover (without using the MediaLive automatic failover feature) and only if // that downstream system has advised you to exclude the tags. DiscontinuityTags HlsDiscontinuityTags // Encrypts the segments with the given encryption scheme. Exclude this parameter // if no encryption is desired. EncryptionType HlsEncryptionType // Parameters that control interactions with the CDN. HlsCdnSettings *HlsCdnSettings // State of HLS ID3 Segment Tagging HlsId3SegmentTagging HlsId3SegmentTaggingState // DISABLED: Do not create an I-frame-only manifest, but do create the master and // media manifests (according to the Output Selection field). STANDARD: Create an // I-frame-only manifest for each output that contains video, as well as the other // manifests (according to the Output Selection field). The I-frame manifest // contains a #EXT-X-I-FRAMES-ONLY tag to indicate it is I-frame only, and one or // more #EXT-X-BYTERANGE entries identifying the I-frame position. For example, // #EXT-X-BYTERANGE:160364@1461888" IFrameOnlyPlaylists IFrameOnlyPlaylistType // Specifies whether to include the final (incomplete) segment in the media output // when the pipeline stops producing output because of a channel stop, a channel // pause or a loss of input to the pipeline. Auto means that MediaLive decides // whether to include the final segment, depending on the channel class and the // types of output groups. Suppress means to never include the incomplete segment. // We recommend you choose Auto and let MediaLive control the behavior. IncompleteSegmentBehavior HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior // Applies only if Mode field is LIVE. Specifies the maximum number of segments in // the media manifest file. After this maximum, older segments are removed from the // media manifest. This number must be smaller than the number in the Keep Segments // field. IndexNSegments int32 // Parameter that control output group behavior on input loss. InputLossAction InputLossActionForHlsOut // For use with encryptionType. The IV (Initialization Vector) is a 128-bit number // used in conjunction with the key for encrypting blocks. If set to "include", IV // is listed in the manifest, otherwise the IV is not in the manifest. IvInManifest HlsIvInManifest // For use with encryptionType. The IV (Initialization Vector) is a 128-bit number // used in conjunction with the key for encrypting blocks. If this setting is // "followsSegmentNumber", it will cause the IV to change every segment (to match // the segment number). If this is set to "explicit", you must enter a constantIv // value. IvSource HlsIvSource // Applies only if Mode field is LIVE. Specifies the number of media segments to // retain in the destination directory. This number should be bigger than // indexNSegments (Num segments). We recommend (value = (2 x indexNsegments) + 1). // If this "keep segments" number is too low, the following might happen: the // player is still reading a media manifest file that lists this segment, but that // segment has been removed from the destination directory (as directed by // indexNSegments). This situation would result in a 404 HTTP error on the player. KeepSegments int32 // The value specifies how the key is represented in the resource identified by the // URI. If parameter is absent, an implicit value of "identity" is used. A reverse // DNS string can also be given. KeyFormat *string // Either a single positive integer version value or a slash delimited list of // version values (1/2/3). KeyFormatVersions *string // The key provider settings. KeyProviderSettings *KeyProviderSettings // When set to gzip, compresses HLS playlist. ManifestCompression HlsManifestCompression // Indicates whether the output manifest should use floating point or integer // values for segment duration. ManifestDurationFormat HlsManifestDurationFormat // When set, minimumSegmentLength is enforced by looking ahead and back within the // specified range for a nearby avail and extending the segment size if needed. MinSegmentLength int32 // If "vod", all segments are indexed and kept permanently in the destination and // manifest. If "live", only the number segments specified in keepSegments and // indexNSegments are kept; newer segments replace older segments, which may // prevent players from rewinding all the way to the beginning of the event. VOD // mode uses HLS EXT-X-PLAYLIST-TYPE of EVENT while the channel is running, // converting it to a "VOD" type manifest on completion of the stream. Mode HlsMode // MANIFESTS_AND_SEGMENTS: Generates manifests (master manifest, if applicable, and // media manifests) for this output group. VARIANT_MANIFESTS_AND_SEGMENTS: // Generates media manifests for this output group, but not a master manifest. // SEGMENTS_ONLY: Does not generate any manifests for this output group. OutputSelection HlsOutputSelection // Includes or excludes EXT-X-PROGRAM-DATE-TIME tag in .m3u8 manifest files. The // value is calculated as follows: either the program date and time are initialized // using the input timecode source, or the time is initialized using the input // timecode source and the date is initialized using the timestampOffset. ProgramDateTime HlsProgramDateTime // Period of insertion of EXT-X-PROGRAM-DATE-TIME entry, in seconds. ProgramDateTimePeriod int32 // ENABLED: The master manifest (.m3u8 file) for each pipeline includes information // about both pipelines: first its own media files, then the media files of the // other pipeline. This feature allows playout device that support stale manifest // detection to switch from one manifest to the other, when the current manifest // seems to be stale. There are still two destinations and two master manifests, // but both master manifests reference the media files from both pipelines. // DISABLED: The master manifest (.m3u8 file) for each pipeline includes // information about its own pipeline only. For an HLS output group with // MediaPackage as the destination, the DISABLED behavior is always followed. // MediaPackage regenerates the manifests it serves to players so a redundant // manifest from MediaLive is irrelevant. RedundantManifest HlsRedundantManifest // Length of MPEG-2 Transport Stream segments to create (in seconds). Note that // segments will end on the next keyframe after this number of seconds, so actual // segment length may be longer. SegmentLength int32 // useInputSegmentation has been deprecated. The configured segment size is always // used. SegmentationMode HlsSegmentationMode // Number of segments to write to a subdirectory before starting a new one. // directoryStructure must be subdirectoryPerStream for this setting to have an // effect. SegmentsPerSubdirectory int32 // Include or exclude RESOLUTION attribute for video in EXT-X-STREAM-INF tag of // variant manifest. StreamInfResolution HlsStreamInfResolution // Indicates ID3 frame that has the timecode. TimedMetadataId3Frame HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame // Timed Metadata interval in seconds. TimedMetadataId3Period int32 // Provides an extra millisecond delta offset to fine tune the timestamps. TimestampDeltaMilliseconds int32 // SEGMENTED_FILES: Emit the program as segments - multiple .ts media files. // SINGLE_FILE: Applies only if Mode field is VOD. Emit the program as a single .ts // media file. The media manifest includes #EXT-X-BYTERANGE tags to index segments // for playback. A typical use for this value is when sending the output to AWS // Elemental MediaConvert, which can accept only a single media file. Playback // while the channel is running is not guaranteed due to HTTP server caching. TsFileMode HlsTsFileMode }
Hls Group Settings
type HlsH265PackagingType ¶
type HlsH265PackagingType string
const ( HlsH265PackagingTypeHev1 HlsH265PackagingType = "HEV1" HlsH265PackagingTypeHvc1 HlsH265PackagingType = "HVC1" )
Enum values for HlsH265PackagingType
func (HlsH265PackagingType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsH265PackagingType) Values() []HlsH265PackagingType
Values returns all known values for HlsH265PackagingType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsId3SegmentTaggingScheduleActionSettings ¶
type HlsId3SegmentTaggingScheduleActionSettings struct { // ID3 tag to insert into each segment. Supports special keyword identifiers to // substitute in segment-related values.\nSupported keyword identifiers: // https://docs.aws.amazon.com/medialive/latest/ug/variable-data-identifiers.html // // This member is required. Tag *string }
Settings for the action to insert a user-defined ID3 tag in each HLS segment
type HlsId3SegmentTaggingState ¶
type HlsId3SegmentTaggingState string
const ( HlsId3SegmentTaggingStateDisabled HlsId3SegmentTaggingState = "DISABLED" HlsId3SegmentTaggingStateEnabled HlsId3SegmentTaggingState = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for HlsId3SegmentTaggingState
func (HlsId3SegmentTaggingState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsId3SegmentTaggingState) Values() []HlsId3SegmentTaggingState
Values returns all known values for HlsId3SegmentTaggingState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior ¶ added in v0.29.0
type HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior string
const ( HlsIncompleteSegmentBehaviorAuto HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior = "AUTO" HlsIncompleteSegmentBehaviorSuppress HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior = "SUPPRESS" )
Enum values for HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior
func (HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior) Values() []HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior
Values returns all known values for HlsIncompleteSegmentBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsInputSettings ¶
type HlsInputSettings struct { // When specified the HLS stream with the m3u8 BANDWIDTH that most closely matches // this value will be chosen, otherwise the highest bandwidth stream in the m3u8 // will be chosen. The bitrate is specified in bits per second, as in an HLS // manifest. Bandwidth int32 // When specified, reading of the HLS input will begin this many buffer segments // from the end (most recently written segment). When not specified, the HLS input // will begin with the first segment specified in the m3u8. BufferSegments int32 // The number of consecutive times that attempts to read a manifest or segment must // fail before the input is considered unavailable. Retries int32 // The number of seconds between retries when an attempt to read a manifest or // segment fails. RetryInterval int32 }
Hls Input Settings
type HlsIvInManifest ¶
type HlsIvInManifest string
const ( HlsIvInManifestExclude HlsIvInManifest = "EXCLUDE" HlsIvInManifestInclude HlsIvInManifest = "INCLUDE" )
Enum values for HlsIvInManifest
func (HlsIvInManifest) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsIvInManifest) Values() []HlsIvInManifest
Values returns all known values for HlsIvInManifest. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsIvSource ¶
type HlsIvSource string
const ( HlsIvSourceExplicit HlsIvSource = "EXPLICIT" HlsIvSourceFollowsSegmentNumber HlsIvSource = "FOLLOWS_SEGMENT_NUMBER" )
Enum values for HlsIvSource
func (HlsIvSource) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsIvSource) Values() []HlsIvSource
Values returns all known values for HlsIvSource. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsManifestCompression ¶
type HlsManifestCompression string
const ( HlsManifestCompressionGzip HlsManifestCompression = "GZIP" HlsManifestCompressionNone HlsManifestCompression = "NONE" )
Enum values for HlsManifestCompression
func (HlsManifestCompression) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsManifestCompression) Values() []HlsManifestCompression
Values returns all known values for HlsManifestCompression. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsManifestDurationFormat ¶
type HlsManifestDurationFormat string
const ( HlsManifestDurationFormatFloatingPoint HlsManifestDurationFormat = "FLOATING_POINT" HlsManifestDurationFormatInteger HlsManifestDurationFormat = "INTEGER" )
Enum values for HlsManifestDurationFormat
func (HlsManifestDurationFormat) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsManifestDurationFormat) Values() []HlsManifestDurationFormat
Values returns all known values for HlsManifestDurationFormat. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsMediaStoreSettings ¶
type HlsMediaStoreSettings struct { // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the // connection is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval int32 // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration int32 // When set to temporal, output files are stored in non-persistent memory for // faster reading and writing. MediaStoreStorageClass HlsMediaStoreStorageClass // Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into an // error state. NumRetries int32 // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay int32 }
Hls Media Store Settings
type HlsMediaStoreStorageClass ¶
type HlsMediaStoreStorageClass string
const (
HlsMediaStoreStorageClassTemporal HlsMediaStoreStorageClass = "TEMPORAL"
)
Enum values for HlsMediaStoreStorageClass
func (HlsMediaStoreStorageClass) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsMediaStoreStorageClass) Values() []HlsMediaStoreStorageClass
Values returns all known values for HlsMediaStoreStorageClass. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsOutputSelection ¶
type HlsOutputSelection string
const ( HlsOutputSelectionManifestsAndSegments HlsOutputSelection = "MANIFESTS_AND_SEGMENTS" HlsOutputSelectionSegmentsOnly HlsOutputSelection = "SEGMENTS_ONLY" HlsOutputSelectionVariantManifestsAndSegments HlsOutputSelection = "VARIANT_MANIFESTS_AND_SEGMENTS" )
Enum values for HlsOutputSelection
func (HlsOutputSelection) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsOutputSelection) Values() []HlsOutputSelection
Values returns all known values for HlsOutputSelection. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsOutputSettings ¶
type HlsOutputSettings struct { // Settings regarding the underlying stream. These settings are different for // audio-only outputs. // // This member is required. HlsSettings *HlsSettings // Only applicable when this output is referencing an H.265 video description. // Specifies whether MP4 segments should be packaged as HEV1 or HVC1. H265PackagingType HlsH265PackagingType // String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Accepts "Format // Identifiers":#formatIdentifierParameters. NameModifier *string // String concatenated to end of segment filenames. SegmentModifier *string }
Hls Output Settings
type HlsProgramDateTime ¶
type HlsProgramDateTime string
const ( HlsProgramDateTimeExclude HlsProgramDateTime = "EXCLUDE" HlsProgramDateTimeInclude HlsProgramDateTime = "INCLUDE" )
Enum values for HlsProgramDateTime
func (HlsProgramDateTime) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsProgramDateTime) Values() []HlsProgramDateTime
Values returns all known values for HlsProgramDateTime. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsRedundantManifest ¶
type HlsRedundantManifest string
const ( HlsRedundantManifestDisabled HlsRedundantManifest = "DISABLED" HlsRedundantManifestEnabled HlsRedundantManifest = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for HlsRedundantManifest
func (HlsRedundantManifest) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsRedundantManifest) Values() []HlsRedundantManifest
Values returns all known values for HlsRedundantManifest. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsS3Settings ¶ added in v1.2.0
type HlsS3Settings struct { // Specify the canned ACL to apply to each S3 request. Defaults to none. CannedAcl S3CannedAcl }
Hls S3 Settings
type HlsSegmentationMode ¶
type HlsSegmentationMode string
const ( HlsSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation HlsSegmentationMode = "USE_INPUT_SEGMENTATION" HlsSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration HlsSegmentationMode = "USE_SEGMENT_DURATION" )
Enum values for HlsSegmentationMode
func (HlsSegmentationMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsSegmentationMode) Values() []HlsSegmentationMode
Values returns all known values for HlsSegmentationMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsSettings ¶
type HlsSettings struct { // Audio Only Hls Settings AudioOnlyHlsSettings *AudioOnlyHlsSettings // Fmp4 Hls Settings Fmp4HlsSettings *Fmp4HlsSettings // Frame Capture Hls Settings FrameCaptureHlsSettings *FrameCaptureHlsSettings // Standard Hls Settings StandardHlsSettings *StandardHlsSettings }
Hls Settings
type HlsStreamInfResolution ¶
type HlsStreamInfResolution string
const ( HlsStreamInfResolutionExclude HlsStreamInfResolution = "EXCLUDE" HlsStreamInfResolutionInclude HlsStreamInfResolution = "INCLUDE" )
Enum values for HlsStreamInfResolution
func (HlsStreamInfResolution) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsStreamInfResolution) Values() []HlsStreamInfResolution
Values returns all known values for HlsStreamInfResolution. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame ¶
type HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame string
const ( HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameNone HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame = "NONE" HlsTimedMetadataId3FramePriv HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame = "PRIV" HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame = "TDRL" )
Enum values for HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame
func (HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame) Values() []HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame
Values returns all known values for HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings ¶
type HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings struct { // Base64 string formatted according to the ID3 specification: // http://id3.org/id3v2.4.0-structure // // This member is required. Id3 *string }
Settings for the action to emit HLS metadata
type HlsTsFileMode ¶
type HlsTsFileMode string
const ( HlsTsFileModeSegmentedFiles HlsTsFileMode = "SEGMENTED_FILES" HlsTsFileModeSingleFile HlsTsFileMode = "SINGLE_FILE" )
Enum values for HlsTsFileMode
func (HlsTsFileMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsTsFileMode) Values() []HlsTsFileMode
Values returns all known values for HlsTsFileMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode ¶
type HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode string
const ( HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeChunked HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode = "CHUNKED" HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeNonChunked HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode = "NON_CHUNKED" )
Enum values for HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode
func (HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode) Values() []HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode
Values returns all known values for HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type HlsWebdavSettings ¶
type HlsWebdavSettings struct { // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the // connection is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval int32 // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration int32 // Specify whether or not to use chunked transfer encoding to WebDAV. HttpTransferMode HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode // Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into an // error state. NumRetries int32 // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay int32 }
Hls Webdav Settings
type HtmlMotionGraphicsSettings ¶ added in v1.4.0
type HtmlMotionGraphicsSettings struct { }
Html Motion Graphics Settings
type IFrameOnlyPlaylistType ¶
type IFrameOnlyPlaylistType string
const ( IFrameOnlyPlaylistTypeDisabled IFrameOnlyPlaylistType = "DISABLED" IFrameOnlyPlaylistTypeStandard IFrameOnlyPlaylistType = "STANDARD" )
Enum values for IFrameOnlyPlaylistType
func (IFrameOnlyPlaylistType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (IFrameOnlyPlaylistType) Values() []IFrameOnlyPlaylistType
Values returns all known values for IFrameOnlyPlaylistType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ImmediateModeScheduleActionStartSettings ¶
type ImmediateModeScheduleActionStartSettings struct { }
Settings to configure an action so that it occurs as soon as possible.
type Input ¶
type Input struct { // The Unique ARN of the input (generated, immutable). Arn *string // A list of channel IDs that that input is attached to (currently an input can // only be attached to one channel). AttachedChannels []string // A list of the destinations of the input (PUSH-type). Destinations []InputDestination // The generated ID of the input (unique for user account, immutable). Id *string // STANDARD - MediaLive expects two sources to be connected to this input. If the // channel is also STANDARD, both sources will be ingested. If the channel is // SINGLE_PIPELINE, only the first source will be ingested; the second source will // always be ignored, even if the first source fails. SINGLE_PIPELINE - You can // connect only one source to this input. If the ChannelClass is also // SINGLE_PIPELINE, this value is valid. If the ChannelClass is STANDARD, this // value is not valid because the channel requires two sources in the input. InputClass InputClass // Settings for the input devices. InputDevices []InputDeviceSettings // A list of IDs for all Inputs which are partners of this one. InputPartnerIds []string // Certain pull input sources can be dynamic, meaning that they can have their // URL's dynamically changes during input switch actions. Presently, this // functionality only works with MP4_FILE inputs. InputSourceType InputSourceType // A list of MediaConnect Flows for this input. MediaConnectFlows []MediaConnectFlow // The user-assigned name (This is a mutable value). Name *string // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role this input assumes during and after // creation. RoleArn *string // A list of IDs for all the Input Security Groups attached to the input. SecurityGroups []string // A list of the sources of the input (PULL-type). Sources []InputSource // Placeholder documentation for InputState State InputState // A collection of key-value pairs. Tags map[string]string // Placeholder documentation for InputType Type InputType }
Placeholder documentation for Input
type InputAttachment ¶
type InputAttachment struct { // User-specified settings for defining what the conditions are for declaring the // input unhealthy and failing over to a different input. AutomaticInputFailoverSettings *AutomaticInputFailoverSettings // User-specified name for the attachment. This is required if the user wants to // use this input in an input switch action. InputAttachmentName *string // The ID of the input InputId *string // Settings of an input (caption selector, etc.) InputSettings *InputSettings }
Placeholder documentation for InputAttachment
type InputChannelLevel ¶
type InputChannelLevel struct { // Remixing value. Units are in dB and acceptable values are within the range from // -60 (mute) and 6 dB. // // This member is required. Gain int32 // The index of the input channel used as a source. // // This member is required. InputChannel int32 }
Input Channel Level
type InputClass ¶
type InputClass string
const ( InputClassStandard InputClass = "STANDARD" InputClassSinglePipeline InputClass = "SINGLE_PIPELINE" )
Enum values for InputClass
func (InputClass) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputClass) Values() []InputClass
Values returns all known values for InputClass. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputClippingSettings ¶
type InputClippingSettings struct { // The source of the timecodes in the source being clipped. // // This member is required. InputTimecodeSource InputTimecodeSource // Settings to identify the start of the clip. StartTimecode *StartTimecode // Settings to identify the end of the clip. StopTimecode *StopTimecode }
Settings to let you create a clip of the file input, in order to set up the input to ingest only a portion of the file.
type InputCodec ¶
type InputCodec string
const ( InputCodecMpeg2 InputCodec = "MPEG2" InputCodecAvc InputCodec = "AVC" InputCodecHevc InputCodec = "HEVC" )
Enum values for InputCodec
func (InputCodec) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputCodec) Values() []InputCodec
Values returns all known values for InputCodec. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeblockFilter ¶
type InputDeblockFilter string
const ( InputDeblockFilterDisabled InputDeblockFilter = "DISABLED" InputDeblockFilterEnabled InputDeblockFilter = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for InputDeblockFilter
func (InputDeblockFilter) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeblockFilter) Values() []InputDeblockFilter
Values returns all known values for InputDeblockFilter. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDenoiseFilter ¶
type InputDenoiseFilter string
const ( InputDenoiseFilterDisabled InputDenoiseFilter = "DISABLED" InputDenoiseFilterEnabled InputDenoiseFilter = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for InputDenoiseFilter
func (InputDenoiseFilter) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDenoiseFilter) Values() []InputDenoiseFilter
Values returns all known values for InputDenoiseFilter. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDestination ¶
type InputDestination struct { // The system-generated static IP address of endpoint. It remains fixed for the // lifetime of the input. Ip *string // The port number for the input. Port *string // This represents the endpoint that the customer stream will be pushed to. Url *string // The properties for a VPC type input destination. Vpc *InputDestinationVpc }
The settings for a PUSH type input.
type InputDestinationRequest ¶
type InputDestinationRequest struct { // A unique name for the location the RTMP stream is being pushed to. StreamName *string }
Endpoint settings for a PUSH type input.
type InputDestinationVpc ¶
type InputDestinationVpc struct { // The availability zone of the Input destination. AvailabilityZone *string // The network interface ID of the Input destination in the VPC. NetworkInterfaceId *string }
The properties for a VPC type input destination.
type InputDeviceActiveInput ¶
type InputDeviceActiveInput string
const ( InputDeviceActiveInputHdmi InputDeviceActiveInput = "HDMI" InputDeviceActiveInputSdi InputDeviceActiveInput = "SDI" )
Enum values for InputDeviceActiveInput
func (InputDeviceActiveInput) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeviceActiveInput) Values() []InputDeviceActiveInput
Values returns all known values for InputDeviceActiveInput. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeviceConfigurableSettings ¶
type InputDeviceConfigurableSettings struct { // The input source that you want to use. If the device has a source connected to // only one of its input ports, or if you don't care which source the device sends, // specify Auto. If the device has sources connected to both its input ports, and // you want to use a specific source, specify the source. ConfiguredInput InputDeviceConfiguredInput // The maximum bitrate in bits per second. Set a value here to throttle the bitrate // of the source video. MaxBitrate int32 }
Configurable settings for the input device.
type InputDeviceConfiguredInput ¶
type InputDeviceConfiguredInput string
const ( InputDeviceConfiguredInputAuto InputDeviceConfiguredInput = "AUTO" InputDeviceConfiguredInputHdmi InputDeviceConfiguredInput = "HDMI" InputDeviceConfiguredInputSdi InputDeviceConfiguredInput = "SDI" )
Enum values for InputDeviceConfiguredInput
func (InputDeviceConfiguredInput) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeviceConfiguredInput) Values() []InputDeviceConfiguredInput
Values returns all known values for InputDeviceConfiguredInput. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeviceConnectionState ¶
type InputDeviceConnectionState string
const ( InputDeviceConnectionStateDisconnected InputDeviceConnectionState = "DISCONNECTED" InputDeviceConnectionStateConnected InputDeviceConnectionState = "CONNECTED" )
Enum values for InputDeviceConnectionState
func (InputDeviceConnectionState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeviceConnectionState) Values() []InputDeviceConnectionState
Values returns all known values for InputDeviceConnectionState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeviceHdSettings ¶
type InputDeviceHdSettings struct { // If you specified Auto as the configured input, specifies which of the sources is // currently active (SDI or HDMI). ActiveInput InputDeviceActiveInput // The source at the input device that is currently active. You can specify this // source. ConfiguredInput InputDeviceConfiguredInput // The state of the input device. DeviceState InputDeviceState // The frame rate of the video source. Framerate float64 // The height of the video source, in pixels. Height int32 // The current maximum bitrate for ingesting this source, in bits per second. You // can specify this maximum. MaxBitrate int32 // The scan type of the video source. ScanType InputDeviceScanType // The width of the video source, in pixels. Width int32 }
Settings that describe the active source from the input device, and the video characteristics of that source.
type InputDeviceIpScheme ¶
type InputDeviceIpScheme string
const ( InputDeviceIpSchemeStatic InputDeviceIpScheme = "STATIC" InputDeviceIpSchemeDhcp InputDeviceIpScheme = "DHCP" )
Enum values for InputDeviceIpScheme
func (InputDeviceIpScheme) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeviceIpScheme) Values() []InputDeviceIpScheme
Values returns all known values for InputDeviceIpScheme. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeviceNetworkSettings ¶
type InputDeviceNetworkSettings struct { // The DNS addresses of the input device. DnsAddresses []string // The network gateway IP address. Gateway *string // The IP address of the input device. IpAddress *string // Specifies whether the input device has been configured (outside of MediaLive) to // use a dynamic IP address assignment (DHCP) or a static IP address. IpScheme InputDeviceIpScheme // The subnet mask of the input device. SubnetMask *string }
The network settings for the input device.
type InputDeviceRequest ¶
type InputDeviceRequest struct { // The unique ID for the device. Id *string }
Settings for an input device.
type InputDeviceScanType ¶
type InputDeviceScanType string
const ( InputDeviceScanTypeInterlaced InputDeviceScanType = "INTERLACED" InputDeviceScanTypeProgressive InputDeviceScanType = "PROGRESSIVE" )
Enum values for InputDeviceScanType
func (InputDeviceScanType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeviceScanType) Values() []InputDeviceScanType
Values returns all known values for InputDeviceScanType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeviceSettings ¶
type InputDeviceSettings struct { // The unique ID for the device. Id *string }
Settings for an input device.
type InputDeviceState ¶
type InputDeviceState string
const ( InputDeviceStateIdle InputDeviceState = "IDLE" InputDeviceStateStreaming InputDeviceState = "STREAMING" )
Enum values for InputDeviceState
func (InputDeviceState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeviceState) Values() []InputDeviceState
Values returns all known values for InputDeviceState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeviceSummary ¶
type InputDeviceSummary struct { // The unique ARN of the input device. Arn *string // The state of the connection between the input device and AWS. ConnectionState InputDeviceConnectionState // The status of the action to synchronize the device configuration. If you change // the configuration of the input device (for example, the maximum bitrate), // MediaLive sends the new data to the device. The device might not update itself // immediately. SYNCED means the device has updated its configuration. SYNCING // means that it has not updated its configuration. DeviceSettingsSyncState DeviceSettingsSyncState // The status of software on the input device. DeviceUpdateStatus DeviceUpdateStatus // Settings that describe an input device that is type HD. HdDeviceSettings *InputDeviceHdSettings // The unique ID of the input device. Id *string // The network MAC address of the input device. MacAddress *string // A name that you specify for the input device. Name *string // Network settings for the input device. NetworkSettings *InputDeviceNetworkSettings // The unique serial number of the input device. SerialNumber *string // The type of the input device. Type InputDeviceType // Settings that describe an input device that is type UHD. UhdDeviceSettings *InputDeviceUhdSettings }
Details of the input device.
type InputDeviceTransferType ¶ added in v0.29.0
type InputDeviceTransferType string
const ( InputDeviceTransferTypeOutgoing InputDeviceTransferType = "OUTGOING" InputDeviceTransferTypeIncoming InputDeviceTransferType = "INCOMING" )
Enum values for InputDeviceTransferType
func (InputDeviceTransferType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeviceTransferType) Values() []InputDeviceTransferType
Values returns all known values for InputDeviceTransferType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeviceType ¶
type InputDeviceType string
const (
InputDeviceTypeHd InputDeviceType = "HD"
)
Enum values for InputDeviceType
func (InputDeviceType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputDeviceType) Values() []InputDeviceType
Values returns all known values for InputDeviceType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputDeviceUhdSettings ¶ added in v0.31.0
type InputDeviceUhdSettings struct { // If you specified Auto as the configured input, specifies which of the sources is // currently active (SDI or HDMI). ActiveInput InputDeviceActiveInput // The source at the input device that is currently active. You can specify this // source. ConfiguredInput InputDeviceConfiguredInput // The state of the input device. DeviceState InputDeviceState // The frame rate of the video source. Framerate float64 // The height of the video source, in pixels. Height int32 // The current maximum bitrate for ingesting this source, in bits per second. You // can specify this maximum. MaxBitrate int32 // The scan type of the video source. ScanType InputDeviceScanType // The width of the video source, in pixels. Width int32 }
Settings that describe the active source from the input device, and the video characteristics of that source.
type InputFilter ¶
type InputFilter string
const ( InputFilterAuto InputFilter = "AUTO" InputFilterDisabled InputFilter = "DISABLED" InputFilterForced InputFilter = "FORCED" )
Enum values for InputFilter
func (InputFilter) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputFilter) Values() []InputFilter
Values returns all known values for InputFilter. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputLocation ¶
type InputLocation struct { // Uniform Resource Identifier - This should be a path to a file accessible to the // Live system (eg. a http:// URI) depending on the output type. For example, a // RTMP destination should have a uri simliar to: "rtmp://fmsserver/live". // // This member is required. Uri *string // key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store PasswordParam *string // Documentation update needed Username *string }
Input Location
type InputLossActionForHlsOut ¶
type InputLossActionForHlsOut string
const ( InputLossActionForHlsOutEmitOutput InputLossActionForHlsOut = "EMIT_OUTPUT" InputLossActionForHlsOutPauseOutput InputLossActionForHlsOut = "PAUSE_OUTPUT" )
Enum values for InputLossActionForHlsOut
func (InputLossActionForHlsOut) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputLossActionForHlsOut) Values() []InputLossActionForHlsOut
Values returns all known values for InputLossActionForHlsOut. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut ¶
type InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut string
const ( InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutEmitOutput InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut = "EMIT_OUTPUT" InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutPauseOutput InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut = "PAUSE_OUTPUT" )
Enum values for InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut
func (InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut) Values() []InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut
Values returns all known values for InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputLossActionForRtmpOut ¶
type InputLossActionForRtmpOut string
const ( InputLossActionForRtmpOutEmitOutput InputLossActionForRtmpOut = "EMIT_OUTPUT" InputLossActionForRtmpOutPauseOutput InputLossActionForRtmpOut = "PAUSE_OUTPUT" )
Enum values for InputLossActionForRtmpOut
func (InputLossActionForRtmpOut) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputLossActionForRtmpOut) Values() []InputLossActionForRtmpOut
Values returns all known values for InputLossActionForRtmpOut. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputLossActionForUdpOut ¶
type InputLossActionForUdpOut string
const ( InputLossActionForUdpOutDropProgram InputLossActionForUdpOut = "DROP_PROGRAM" InputLossActionForUdpOutDropTs InputLossActionForUdpOut = "DROP_TS" InputLossActionForUdpOutEmitProgram InputLossActionForUdpOut = "EMIT_PROGRAM" )
Enum values for InputLossActionForUdpOut
func (InputLossActionForUdpOut) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputLossActionForUdpOut) Values() []InputLossActionForUdpOut
Values returns all known values for InputLossActionForUdpOut. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputLossBehavior ¶
type InputLossBehavior struct { // Documentation update needed BlackFrameMsec int32 // When input loss image type is "color" this field specifies the color to use. // Value: 6 hex characters representing the values of RGB. InputLossImageColor *string // When input loss image type is "slate" these fields specify the parameters for // accessing the slate. InputLossImageSlate *InputLocation // Indicates whether to substitute a solid color or a slate into the output after // input loss exceeds blackFrameMsec. InputLossImageType InputLossImageType // Documentation update needed RepeatFrameMsec int32 }
Input Loss Behavior
type InputLossFailoverSettings ¶ added in v0.29.0
type InputLossFailoverSettings struct { // The amount of time (in milliseconds) that no input is detected. After that time, // an input failover will occur. InputLossThresholdMsec int32 }
MediaLive will perform a failover if content is not detected in this input for the specified period.
type InputLossImageType ¶
type InputLossImageType string
const ( InputLossImageTypeColor InputLossImageType = "COLOR" InputLossImageTypeSlate InputLossImageType = "SLATE" )
Enum values for InputLossImageType
func (InputLossImageType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputLossImageType) Values() []InputLossImageType
Values returns all known values for InputLossImageType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputMaximumBitrate ¶
type InputMaximumBitrate string
const ( InputMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps InputMaximumBitrate = "MAX_10_MBPS" InputMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps InputMaximumBitrate = "MAX_20_MBPS" InputMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps InputMaximumBitrate = "MAX_50_MBPS" )
Enum values for InputMaximumBitrate
func (InputMaximumBitrate) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputMaximumBitrate) Values() []InputMaximumBitrate
Values returns all known values for InputMaximumBitrate. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputPreference ¶
type InputPreference string
const ( InputPreferenceEqualInputPreference InputPreference = "EQUAL_INPUT_PREFERENCE" InputPreferencePrimaryInputPreferred InputPreference = "PRIMARY_INPUT_PREFERRED" )
Enum values for InputPreference
func (InputPreference) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputPreference) Values() []InputPreference
Values returns all known values for InputPreference. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputPrepareScheduleActionSettings ¶
type InputPrepareScheduleActionSettings struct { // The name of the input attachment that should be prepared by this action. If no // name is provided, the action will stop the most recent prepare (if any) when // activated. InputAttachmentNameReference *string // Settings to let you create a clip of the file input, in order to set up the // input to ingest only a portion of the file. InputClippingSettings *InputClippingSettings // The value for the variable portion of the URL for the dynamic input, for this // instance of the input. Each time you use the same dynamic input in an input // switch action, you can provide a different value, in order to connect the input // to a different content source. UrlPath []string }
Action to prepare an input for a future immediate input switch.
type InputResolution ¶
type InputResolution string
const ( InputResolutionSd InputResolution = "SD" InputResolutionHd InputResolution = "HD" InputResolutionUhd InputResolution = "UHD" )
Enum values for InputResolution
func (InputResolution) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputResolution) Values() []InputResolution
Values returns all known values for InputResolution. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputSecurityGroup ¶
type InputSecurityGroup struct { // Unique ARN of Input Security Group Arn *string // The Id of the Input Security Group Id *string // The list of inputs currently using this Input Security Group. Inputs []string // The current state of the Input Security Group. State InputSecurityGroupState // A collection of key-value pairs. Tags map[string]string // Whitelist rules and their sync status WhitelistRules []InputWhitelistRule }
An Input Security Group
type InputSecurityGroupState ¶
type InputSecurityGroupState string
const ( InputSecurityGroupStateIdle InputSecurityGroupState = "IDLE" InputSecurityGroupStateInUse InputSecurityGroupState = "IN_USE" InputSecurityGroupStateUpdating InputSecurityGroupState = "UPDATING" InputSecurityGroupStateDeleted InputSecurityGroupState = "DELETED" )
Enum values for InputSecurityGroupState
func (InputSecurityGroupState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputSecurityGroupState) Values() []InputSecurityGroupState
Values returns all known values for InputSecurityGroupState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputSettings ¶
type InputSettings struct { // Used to select the audio stream to decode for inputs that have multiple // available. AudioSelectors []AudioSelector // Used to select the caption input to use for inputs that have multiple available. CaptionSelectors []CaptionSelector // Enable or disable the deblock filter when filtering. DeblockFilter InputDeblockFilter // Enable or disable the denoise filter when filtering. DenoiseFilter InputDenoiseFilter // Adjusts the magnitude of filtering from 1 (minimal) to 5 (strongest). FilterStrength int32 // Turns on the filter for this input. MPEG-2 inputs have the deblocking filter // enabled by default. // // * auto - filtering will be applied depending on input // type/quality // // * disabled - no filtering will be applied to the input // // * forced - // filtering will be applied regardless of input type InputFilter InputFilter // Input settings. NetworkInputSettings *NetworkInputSettings // Specifies whether to extract applicable ancillary data from a SMPTE-2038 source // in this input. Applicable data types are captions, timecode, AFD, and SCTE-104 // messages. // // * PREFER: Extract from SMPTE-2038 if present in this input, otherwise // extract from another source (if any). // // * IGNORE: Never extract any ancillary // data from SMPTE-2038. Smpte2038DataPreference Smpte2038DataPreference // Loop input if it is a file. This allows a file input to be streamed // indefinitely. SourceEndBehavior InputSourceEndBehavior // Informs which video elementary stream to decode for input types that have // multiple available. VideoSelector *VideoSelector }
Live Event input parameters. There can be multiple inputs in a single Live Event.
type InputSource ¶
type InputSource struct { // The key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store. PasswordParam *string // This represents the customer's source URL where stream is pulled from. Url *string // The username for the input source. Username *string }
The settings for a PULL type input.
type InputSourceEndBehavior ¶
type InputSourceEndBehavior string
const ( InputSourceEndBehaviorContinue InputSourceEndBehavior = "CONTINUE" InputSourceEndBehaviorLoop InputSourceEndBehavior = "LOOP" )
Enum values for InputSourceEndBehavior
func (InputSourceEndBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputSourceEndBehavior) Values() []InputSourceEndBehavior
Values returns all known values for InputSourceEndBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputSourceRequest ¶
type InputSourceRequest struct { // The key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store. PasswordParam *string // This represents the customer's source URL where stream is pulled from. Url *string // The username for the input source. Username *string }
Settings for for a PULL type input.
type InputSourceType ¶
type InputSourceType string
const ( InputSourceTypeStatic InputSourceType = "STATIC" InputSourceTypeDynamic InputSourceType = "DYNAMIC" )
Enum values for InputSourceType
func (InputSourceType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputSourceType) Values() []InputSourceType
Values returns all known values for InputSourceType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputSpecification ¶
type InputSpecification struct { // Input codec Codec InputCodec // Maximum input bitrate, categorized coarsely MaximumBitrate InputMaximumBitrate // Input resolution, categorized coarsely Resolution InputResolution }
Placeholder documentation for InputSpecification
type InputState ¶
type InputState string
const ( InputStateCreating InputState = "CREATING" InputStateDetached InputState = "DETACHED" InputStateAttached InputState = "ATTACHED" InputStateDeleting InputState = "DELETING" InputStateDeleted InputState = "DELETED" )
Enum values for InputState
func (InputState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputState) Values() []InputState
Values returns all known values for InputState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings ¶
type InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings struct { // The name of the input attachment (not the name of the input!) to switch to. The // name is specified in the channel configuration. // // This member is required. InputAttachmentNameReference *string // Settings to let you create a clip of the file input, in order to set up the // input to ingest only a portion of the file. InputClippingSettings *InputClippingSettings // The value for the variable portion of the URL for the dynamic input, for this // instance of the input. Each time you use the same dynamic input in an input // switch action, you can provide a different value, in order to connect the input // to a different content source. UrlPath []string }
Settings for the "switch input" action: to switch from ingesting one input to ingesting another input.
type InputTimecodeSource ¶
type InputTimecodeSource string
const ( InputTimecodeSourceZerobased InputTimecodeSource = "ZEROBASED" InputTimecodeSourceEmbedded InputTimecodeSource = "EMBEDDED" )
Enum values for InputTimecodeSource
func (InputTimecodeSource) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (InputTimecodeSource) Values() []InputTimecodeSource
Values returns all known values for InputTimecodeSource. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type InputType ¶
type InputType string
const ( InputTypeUdpPush InputType = "UDP_PUSH" InputTypeRtpPush InputType = "RTP_PUSH" InputTypeRtmpPush InputType = "RTMP_PUSH" InputTypeRtmpPull InputType = "RTMP_PULL" InputTypeUrlPull InputType = "URL_PULL" InputTypeMp4File InputType = "MP4_FILE" InputTypeMediaconnect InputType = "MEDIACONNECT" InputTypeInputDevice InputType = "INPUT_DEVICE" InputTypeAwsCdi InputType = "AWS_CDI" )
Enum values for InputType
type InputVpcRequest ¶
type InputVpcRequest struct { // A list of 2 VPC subnet IDs from the same VPC. Subnet IDs must be mapped to two // unique availability zones (AZ). // // This member is required. SubnetIds []string // A list of up to 5 EC2 VPC security group IDs to attach to the Input VPC network // interfaces. Requires subnetIds. If none are specified then the VPC default // security group will be used. SecurityGroupIds []string }
Settings for a private VPC Input. When this property is specified, the input destination addresses will be created in a VPC rather than with public Internet addresses. This property requires setting the roleArn property on Input creation. Not compatible with the inputSecurityGroups property.
type InputWhitelistRule ¶
type InputWhitelistRule struct { // The IPv4 CIDR that's whitelisted. Cidr *string }
Whitelist rule
type InputWhitelistRuleCidr ¶
type InputWhitelistRuleCidr struct { // The IPv4 CIDR to whitelist. Cidr *string }
An IPv4 CIDR to whitelist.
type InternalServerErrorException ¶
type InternalServerErrorException struct {
Message *string
}
Placeholder documentation for InternalServerErrorException
func (*InternalServerErrorException) Error ¶
func (e *InternalServerErrorException) Error() string
func (*InternalServerErrorException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *InternalServerErrorException) ErrorCode() string
func (*InternalServerErrorException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *InternalServerErrorException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*InternalServerErrorException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *InternalServerErrorException) ErrorMessage() string
type KeyProviderSettings ¶
type KeyProviderSettings struct { // Static Key Settings StaticKeySettings *StaticKeySettings }
Key Provider Settings
type LastFrameClippingBehavior ¶
type LastFrameClippingBehavior string
const ( LastFrameClippingBehaviorExcludeLastFrame LastFrameClippingBehavior = "EXCLUDE_LAST_FRAME" LastFrameClippingBehaviorIncludeLastFrame LastFrameClippingBehavior = "INCLUDE_LAST_FRAME" )
Enum values for LastFrameClippingBehavior
func (LastFrameClippingBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (LastFrameClippingBehavior) Values() []LastFrameClippingBehavior
Values returns all known values for LastFrameClippingBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type LogLevel ¶
type LogLevel string
type M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior ¶
type M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior string
const ( M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorDrop M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior = "DROP" M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorEncodeSilence M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior = "ENCODE_SILENCE" )
Enum values for M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior
func (M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior) Values() []M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior
Values returns all known values for M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl ¶
type M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl string
const ( M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlAuto M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl = "AUTO" M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlUseConfigured M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl = "USE_CONFIGURED" )
Enum values for M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl
func (M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl) Values() []M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl
Values returns all known values for M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsAudioBufferModel ¶
type M2tsAudioBufferModel string
const ( M2tsAudioBufferModelAtsc M2tsAudioBufferModel = "ATSC" M2tsAudioBufferModelDvb M2tsAudioBufferModel = "DVB" )
Enum values for M2tsAudioBufferModel
func (M2tsAudioBufferModel) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsAudioBufferModel) Values() []M2tsAudioBufferModel
Values returns all known values for M2tsAudioBufferModel. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsAudioInterval ¶
type M2tsAudioInterval string
const ( M2tsAudioIntervalVideoAndFixedIntervals M2tsAudioInterval = "VIDEO_AND_FIXED_INTERVALS" M2tsAudioIntervalVideoInterval M2tsAudioInterval = "VIDEO_INTERVAL" )
Enum values for M2tsAudioInterval
func (M2tsAudioInterval) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsAudioInterval) Values() []M2tsAudioInterval
Values returns all known values for M2tsAudioInterval. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsAudioStreamType ¶
type M2tsAudioStreamType string
const ( M2tsAudioStreamTypeAtsc M2tsAudioStreamType = "ATSC" M2tsAudioStreamTypeDvb M2tsAudioStreamType = "DVB" )
Enum values for M2tsAudioStreamType
func (M2tsAudioStreamType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsAudioStreamType) Values() []M2tsAudioStreamType
Values returns all known values for M2tsAudioStreamType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsBufferModel ¶
type M2tsBufferModel string
const ( M2tsBufferModelMultiplex M2tsBufferModel = "MULTIPLEX" M2tsBufferModelNone M2tsBufferModel = "NONE" )
Enum values for M2tsBufferModel
func (M2tsBufferModel) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsBufferModel) Values() []M2tsBufferModel
Values returns all known values for M2tsBufferModel. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsCcDescriptor ¶
type M2tsCcDescriptor string
const ( M2tsCcDescriptorDisabled M2tsCcDescriptor = "DISABLED" M2tsCcDescriptorEnabled M2tsCcDescriptor = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for M2tsCcDescriptor
func (M2tsCcDescriptor) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsCcDescriptor) Values() []M2tsCcDescriptor
Values returns all known values for M2tsCcDescriptor. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsEbifControl ¶
type M2tsEbifControl string
const ( M2tsEbifControlNone M2tsEbifControl = "NONE" M2tsEbifControlPassthrough M2tsEbifControl = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for M2tsEbifControl
func (M2tsEbifControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsEbifControl) Values() []M2tsEbifControl
Values returns all known values for M2tsEbifControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsEbpPlacement ¶
type M2tsEbpPlacement string
const ( M2tsEbpPlacementVideoAndAudioPids M2tsEbpPlacement = "VIDEO_AND_AUDIO_PIDS" M2tsEbpPlacementVideoPid M2tsEbpPlacement = "VIDEO_PID" )
Enum values for M2tsEbpPlacement
func (M2tsEbpPlacement) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsEbpPlacement) Values() []M2tsEbpPlacement
Values returns all known values for M2tsEbpPlacement. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsEsRateInPes ¶
type M2tsEsRateInPes string
const ( M2tsEsRateInPesExclude M2tsEsRateInPes = "EXCLUDE" M2tsEsRateInPesInclude M2tsEsRateInPes = "INCLUDE" )
Enum values for M2tsEsRateInPes
func (M2tsEsRateInPes) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsEsRateInPes) Values() []M2tsEsRateInPes
Values returns all known values for M2tsEsRateInPes. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsNielsenId3Behavior ¶
type M2tsNielsenId3Behavior string
const ( M2tsNielsenId3BehaviorNoPassthrough M2tsNielsenId3Behavior = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" M2tsNielsenId3BehaviorPassthrough M2tsNielsenId3Behavior = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for M2tsNielsenId3Behavior
func (M2tsNielsenId3Behavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsNielsenId3Behavior) Values() []M2tsNielsenId3Behavior
Values returns all known values for M2tsNielsenId3Behavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsPcrControl ¶
type M2tsPcrControl string
const ( M2tsPcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod M2tsPcrControl = "CONFIGURED_PCR_PERIOD" M2tsPcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket M2tsPcrControl = "PCR_EVERY_PES_PACKET" )
Enum values for M2tsPcrControl
func (M2tsPcrControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsPcrControl) Values() []M2tsPcrControl
Values returns all known values for M2tsPcrControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsRateMode ¶
type M2tsRateMode string
const ( M2tsRateModeCbr M2tsRateMode = "CBR" M2tsRateModeVbr M2tsRateMode = "VBR" )
Enum values for M2tsRateMode
func (M2tsRateMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsRateMode) Values() []M2tsRateMode
Values returns all known values for M2tsRateMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsScte35Control ¶
type M2tsScte35Control string
const ( M2tsScte35ControlNone M2tsScte35Control = "NONE" M2tsScte35ControlPassthrough M2tsScte35Control = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for M2tsScte35Control
func (M2tsScte35Control) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsScte35Control) Values() []M2tsScte35Control
Values returns all known values for M2tsScte35Control. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsSegmentationMarkers ¶
type M2tsSegmentationMarkers string
const ( M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbp M2tsSegmentationMarkers = "EBP" M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbpLegacy M2tsSegmentationMarkers = "EBP_LEGACY" M2tsSegmentationMarkersNone M2tsSegmentationMarkers = "NONE" M2tsSegmentationMarkersPsiSegstart M2tsSegmentationMarkers = "PSI_SEGSTART" M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiAdapt M2tsSegmentationMarkers = "RAI_ADAPT" M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiSegstart M2tsSegmentationMarkers = "RAI_SEGSTART" )
Enum values for M2tsSegmentationMarkers
func (M2tsSegmentationMarkers) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsSegmentationMarkers) Values() []M2tsSegmentationMarkers
Values returns all known values for M2tsSegmentationMarkers. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsSegmentationStyle ¶
type M2tsSegmentationStyle string
const ( M2tsSegmentationStyleMaintainCadence M2tsSegmentationStyle = "MAINTAIN_CADENCE" M2tsSegmentationStyleResetCadence M2tsSegmentationStyle = "RESET_CADENCE" )
Enum values for M2tsSegmentationStyle
func (M2tsSegmentationStyle) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsSegmentationStyle) Values() []M2tsSegmentationStyle
Values returns all known values for M2tsSegmentationStyle. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M2tsSettings ¶
type M2tsSettings struct { // When set to drop, output audio streams will be removed from the program if the // selected input audio stream is removed from the input. This allows the output // audio configuration to dynamically change based on input configuration. If this // is set to encodeSilence, all output audio streams will output encoded silence // when not connected to an active input stream. AbsentInputAudioBehavior M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior // When set to enabled, uses ARIB-compliant field muxing and removes video // descriptor. Arib M2tsArib // Packet Identifier (PID) for ARIB Captions in the transport stream. Can be // entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or 0x20)..8182 // (or 0x1ff6). AribCaptionsPid *string // If set to auto, pid number used for ARIB Captions will be auto-selected from // unused pids. If set to useConfigured, ARIB Captions will be on the configured // pid number. AribCaptionsPidControl M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl // When set to dvb, uses DVB buffer model for Dolby Digital audio. When set to // atsc, the ATSC model is used. AudioBufferModel M2tsAudioBufferModel // The number of audio frames to insert for each PES packet. AudioFramesPerPes int32 // Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary audio stream(s) in the transport // stream. Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by // comma separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID // specified must be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). AudioPids *string // When set to atsc, uses stream type = 0x81 for AC3 and stream type = 0x87 for // EAC3. When set to dvb, uses stream type = 0x06. AudioStreamType M2tsAudioStreamType // The output bitrate of the transport stream in bits per second. Setting to 0 lets // the muxer automatically determine the appropriate bitrate. Bitrate int32 // Controls the timing accuracy for output network traffic. Leave as MULTIPLEX to // ensure accurate network packet timing. Or set to NONE, which might result in // lower latency but will result in more variability in output network packet // timing. This variability might cause interruptions, jitter, or bursty behavior // in your playback or receiving devices. BufferModel M2tsBufferModel // When set to enabled, generates captionServiceDescriptor in PMT. CcDescriptor M2tsCcDescriptor // Inserts DVB Network Information Table (NIT) at the specified table repetition // interval. DvbNitSettings *DvbNitSettings // Inserts DVB Service Description Table (SDT) at the specified table repetition // interval. DvbSdtSettings *DvbSdtSettings // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source DVB Subtitle data to this output. // Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma // separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified // must be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). DvbSubPids *string // Inserts DVB Time and Date Table (TDT) at the specified table repetition // interval. DvbTdtSettings *DvbTdtSettings // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source DVB Teletext data to this output. Can // be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). DvbTeletextPid *string // If set to passthrough, passes any EBIF data from the input source to this // output. Ebif M2tsEbifControl // When videoAndFixedIntervals is selected, audio EBP markers will be added to // partitions 3 and 4. The interval between these additional markers will be fixed, // and will be slightly shorter than the video EBP marker interval. Only available // when EBP Cablelabs segmentation markers are selected. Partitions 1 and 2 will // always follow the video interval. EbpAudioInterval M2tsAudioInterval // When set, enforces that Encoder Boundary Points do not come within the specified // time interval of each other by looking ahead at input video. If another EBP is // going to come in within the specified time interval, the current EBP is not // emitted, and the segment is "stretched" to the next marker. The lookahead value // does not add latency to the system. The Live Event must be configured elsewhere // to create sufficient latency to make the lookahead accurate. EbpLookaheadMs int32 // Controls placement of EBP on Audio PIDs. If set to videoAndAudioPids, EBP // markers will be placed on the video PID and all audio PIDs. If set to videoPid, // EBP markers will be placed on only the video PID. EbpPlacement M2tsEbpPlacement // This field is unused and deprecated. EcmPid *string // Include or exclude the ES Rate field in the PES header. EsRateInPes M2tsEsRateInPes // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source ETV Platform data to this output. Can // be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). EtvPlatformPid *string // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source ETV Signal data to this output. Can be // entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or 0x20)..8182 // (or 0x1ff6). EtvSignalPid *string // The length in seconds of each fragment. Only used with EBP markers. FragmentTime float64 // If set to passthrough, passes any KLV data from the input source to this output. Klv M2tsKlv // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source KLV data to this output. Multiple // values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma separation. // Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified must be in // the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). KlvDataPids *string // If set to passthrough, Nielsen inaudible tones for media tracking will be // detected in the input audio and an equivalent ID3 tag will be inserted in the // output. NielsenId3Behavior M2tsNielsenId3Behavior // Value in bits per second of extra null packets to insert into the transport // stream. This can be used if a downstream encryption system requires periodic // null packets. NullPacketBitrate float64 // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. Valid values are 0, 10..1000. PatInterval int32 // When set to pcrEveryPesPacket, a Program Clock Reference value is inserted for // every Packetized Elementary Stream (PES) header. This parameter is effective // only when the PCR PID is the same as the video or audio elementary stream. PcrControl M2tsPcrControl // Maximum time in milliseconds between Program Clock Reference (PCRs) inserted // into the transport stream. PcrPeriod int32 // Packet Identifier (PID) of the Program Clock Reference (PCR) in the transport // stream. When no value is given, the encoder will assign the same value as the // Video PID. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 // (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). PcrPid *string // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. Valid values are 0, 10..1000. PmtInterval int32 // Packet Identifier (PID) for the Program Map Table (PMT) in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). PmtPid *string // The value of the program number field in the Program Map Table. ProgramNum int32 // When vbr, does not insert null packets into transport stream to fill specified // bitrate. The bitrate setting acts as the maximum bitrate when vbr is set. RateMode M2tsRateMode // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source SCTE-27 data to this output. Multiple // values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma separation. // Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified must be in // the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). Scte27Pids *string // Optionally pass SCTE-35 signals from the input source to this output. Scte35Control M2tsScte35Control // Packet Identifier (PID) of the SCTE-35 stream in the transport stream. Can be // entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or 0x20)..8182 // (or 0x1ff6). Scte35Pid *string // Inserts segmentation markers at each segmentationTime period. raiSegstart sets // the Random Access Indicator bit in the adaptation field. raiAdapt sets the RAI // bit and adds the current timecode in the private data bytes. psiSegstart inserts // PAT and PMT tables at the start of segments. ebp adds Encoder Boundary Point // information to the adaptation field as per OpenCable specification // OC-SP-EBP-I01-130118. ebpLegacy adds Encoder Boundary Point information to the // adaptation field using a legacy proprietary format. SegmentationMarkers M2tsSegmentationMarkers // The segmentation style parameter controls how segmentation markers are inserted // into the transport stream. With avails, it is possible that segments may be // truncated, which can influence where future segmentation markers are inserted. // When a segmentation style of "resetCadence" is selected and a segment is // truncated due to an avail, we will reset the segmentation cadence. This means // the subsequent segment will have a duration of $segmentationTime seconds. When a // segmentation style of "maintainCadence" is selected and a segment is truncated // due to an avail, we will not reset the segmentation cadence. This means the // subsequent segment will likely be truncated as well. However, all segments after // that will have a duration of $segmentationTime seconds. Note that EBP lookahead // is a slight exception to this rule. SegmentationStyle M2tsSegmentationStyle // The length in seconds of each segment. Required unless markers is set to none. SegmentationTime float64 // When set to passthrough, timed metadata will be passed through from input to // output. TimedMetadataBehavior M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior // Packet Identifier (PID) of the timed metadata stream in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). TimedMetadataPid *string // The value of the transport stream ID field in the Program Map Table. TransportStreamId int32 // Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary video stream in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). VideoPid *string }
M2ts Settings
type M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior ¶
type M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior string
const ( M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior
func (M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior) Values() []M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior
Values returns all known values for M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M3u8NielsenId3Behavior ¶
type M3u8NielsenId3Behavior string
const ( M3u8NielsenId3BehaviorNoPassthrough M3u8NielsenId3Behavior = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" M3u8NielsenId3BehaviorPassthrough M3u8NielsenId3Behavior = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for M3u8NielsenId3Behavior
func (M3u8NielsenId3Behavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M3u8NielsenId3Behavior) Values() []M3u8NielsenId3Behavior
Values returns all known values for M3u8NielsenId3Behavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M3u8PcrControl ¶
type M3u8PcrControl string
const ( M3u8PcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod M3u8PcrControl = "CONFIGURED_PCR_PERIOD" M3u8PcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket M3u8PcrControl = "PCR_EVERY_PES_PACKET" )
Enum values for M3u8PcrControl
func (M3u8PcrControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M3u8PcrControl) Values() []M3u8PcrControl
Values returns all known values for M3u8PcrControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M3u8Scte35Behavior ¶
type M3u8Scte35Behavior string
const ( M3u8Scte35BehaviorNoPassthrough M3u8Scte35Behavior = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" M3u8Scte35BehaviorPassthrough M3u8Scte35Behavior = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for M3u8Scte35Behavior
func (M3u8Scte35Behavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M3u8Scte35Behavior) Values() []M3u8Scte35Behavior
Values returns all known values for M3u8Scte35Behavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type M3u8Settings ¶
type M3u8Settings struct { // The number of audio frames to insert for each PES packet. AudioFramesPerPes int32 // Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary audio stream(s) in the transport // stream. Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by // comma separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. AudioPids *string // This parameter is unused and deprecated. EcmPid *string // If set to passthrough, Nielsen inaudible tones for media tracking will be // detected in the input audio and an equivalent ID3 tag will be inserted in the // output. NielsenId3Behavior M3u8NielsenId3Behavior // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. A value of "0" writes out the PMT once per segment file. PatInterval int32 // When set to pcrEveryPesPacket, a Program Clock Reference value is inserted for // every Packetized Elementary Stream (PES) header. This parameter is effective // only when the PCR PID is the same as the video or audio elementary stream. PcrControl M3u8PcrControl // Maximum time in milliseconds between Program Clock References (PCRs) inserted // into the transport stream. PcrPeriod int32 // Packet Identifier (PID) of the Program Clock Reference (PCR) in the transport // stream. When no value is given, the encoder will assign the same value as the // Video PID. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. PcrPid *string // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. A value of "0" writes out the PMT once per segment file. PmtInterval int32 // Packet Identifier (PID) for the Program Map Table (PMT) in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. PmtPid *string // The value of the program number field in the Program Map Table. ProgramNum int32 // If set to passthrough, passes any SCTE-35 signals from the input source to this // output. Scte35Behavior M3u8Scte35Behavior // Packet Identifier (PID) of the SCTE-35 stream in the transport stream. Can be // entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Scte35Pid *string // When set to passthrough, timed metadata is passed through from input to output. TimedMetadataBehavior M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior // Packet Identifier (PID) of the timed metadata stream in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). TimedMetadataPid *string // The value of the transport stream ID field in the Program Map Table. TransportStreamId int32 // Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary video stream in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. VideoPid *string }
Settings information for the .m3u8 container
type M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior ¶
type M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior string
const ( M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior
func (M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior) Values() []M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior
Values returns all known values for M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type MediaConnectFlow ¶
type MediaConnectFlow struct { // The unique ARN of the MediaConnect Flow being used as a source. FlowArn *string }
The settings for a MediaConnect Flow.
type MediaConnectFlowRequest ¶
type MediaConnectFlowRequest struct { // The ARN of the MediaConnect Flow that you want to use as a source. FlowArn *string }
The settings for a MediaConnect Flow.
type MediaPackageGroupSettings ¶
type MediaPackageGroupSettings struct { // MediaPackage channel destination. // // This member is required. Destination *OutputLocationRef }
Media Package Group Settings
type MediaPackageOutputDestinationSettings ¶
type MediaPackageOutputDestinationSettings struct { // ID of the channel in MediaPackage that is the destination for this output group. // You do not need to specify the individual inputs in MediaPackage; MediaLive will // handle the connection of the two MediaLive pipelines to the two MediaPackage // inputs. The MediaPackage channel and MediaLive channel must be in the same // region. ChannelId *string }
MediaPackage Output Destination Settings
type MediaPackageOutputSettings ¶
type MediaPackageOutputSettings struct { }
Media Package Output Settings
type MotionGraphicsActivateScheduleActionSettings ¶ added in v1.4.0
type MotionGraphicsActivateScheduleActionSettings struct { // Duration (in milliseconds) that motion graphics should render on to the video // stream. Leaving out this property or setting to 0 will result in rendering // continuing until a deactivate action is processed. Duration int64 // Key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store PasswordParam *string // URI of the HTML5 content to be rendered into the live stream. Url *string // Documentation update needed Username *string }
Settings to specify the rendering of motion graphics into the video stream.
type MotionGraphicsConfiguration ¶ added in v1.4.0
type MotionGraphicsConfiguration struct { // Motion Graphics Settings // // This member is required. MotionGraphicsSettings *MotionGraphicsSettings // Motion Graphics Insertion MotionGraphicsInsertion MotionGraphicsInsertion }
Motion Graphics Configuration
type MotionGraphicsDeactivateScheduleActionSettings ¶ added in v1.4.0
type MotionGraphicsDeactivateScheduleActionSettings struct { }
Settings to specify the ending of rendering motion graphics into the video stream.
type MotionGraphicsInsertion ¶ added in v1.4.0
type MotionGraphicsInsertion string
const ( MotionGraphicsInsertionDisabled MotionGraphicsInsertion = "DISABLED" MotionGraphicsInsertionEnabled MotionGraphicsInsertion = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for MotionGraphicsInsertion
func (MotionGraphicsInsertion) Values ¶ added in v1.4.0
func (MotionGraphicsInsertion) Values() []MotionGraphicsInsertion
Values returns all known values for MotionGraphicsInsertion. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type MotionGraphicsSettings ¶ added in v1.4.0
type MotionGraphicsSettings struct { // Html Motion Graphics Settings HtmlMotionGraphicsSettings *HtmlMotionGraphicsSettings }
Motion Graphics Settings
type Mp2CodingMode ¶
type Mp2CodingMode string
const ( Mp2CodingModeCodingMode10 Mp2CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_1_0" Mp2CodingModeCodingMode20 Mp2CodingMode = "CODING_MODE_2_0" )
Enum values for Mp2CodingMode
func (Mp2CodingMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mp2CodingMode) Values() []Mp2CodingMode
Values returns all known values for Mp2CodingMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Mp2Settings ¶
type Mp2Settings struct { // Average bitrate in bits/second. Bitrate float64 // The MPEG2 Audio coding mode. Valid values are codingMode10 (for mono) or // codingMode20 (for stereo). CodingMode Mp2CodingMode // Sample rate in Hz. SampleRate float64 }
Mp2 Settings
type Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization string
const ( Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantizationAuto Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization = "AUTO" Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantizationHigh Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization = "HIGH" Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantizationLow Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization = "LOW" Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantizationMedium Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization = "MEDIUM" Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantizationOff Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization = "OFF" )
Enum values for Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization
func (Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization) Values() []Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization
Values returns all known values for Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Mpeg2ColorMetadata ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2ColorMetadata string
const ( Mpeg2ColorMetadataIgnore Mpeg2ColorMetadata = "IGNORE" Mpeg2ColorMetadataInsert Mpeg2ColorMetadata = "INSERT" )
Enum values for Mpeg2ColorMetadata
func (Mpeg2ColorMetadata) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mpeg2ColorMetadata) Values() []Mpeg2ColorMetadata
Values returns all known values for Mpeg2ColorMetadata. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Mpeg2ColorSpace ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2ColorSpace string
const ( Mpeg2ColorSpaceAuto Mpeg2ColorSpace = "AUTO" Mpeg2ColorSpacePassthrough Mpeg2ColorSpace = "PASSTHROUGH" )
Enum values for Mpeg2ColorSpace
func (Mpeg2ColorSpace) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mpeg2ColorSpace) Values() []Mpeg2ColorSpace
Values returns all known values for Mpeg2ColorSpace. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Mpeg2DisplayRatio ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2DisplayRatio string
const ( Mpeg2DisplayRatioDisplayratio16x9 Mpeg2DisplayRatio = "DISPLAYRATIO16X9" Mpeg2DisplayRatioDisplayratio4x3 Mpeg2DisplayRatio = "DISPLAYRATIO4X3" )
Enum values for Mpeg2DisplayRatio
func (Mpeg2DisplayRatio) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mpeg2DisplayRatio) Values() []Mpeg2DisplayRatio
Values returns all known values for Mpeg2DisplayRatio. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Mpeg2FilterSettings ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2FilterSettings struct { // Temporal Filter Settings TemporalFilterSettings *TemporalFilterSettings }
Mpeg2 Filter Settings
type Mpeg2GopSizeUnits ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2GopSizeUnits string
const ( Mpeg2GopSizeUnitsFrames Mpeg2GopSizeUnits = "FRAMES" Mpeg2GopSizeUnitsSeconds Mpeg2GopSizeUnits = "SECONDS" )
Enum values for Mpeg2GopSizeUnits
func (Mpeg2GopSizeUnits) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mpeg2GopSizeUnits) Values() []Mpeg2GopSizeUnits
Values returns all known values for Mpeg2GopSizeUnits. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Mpeg2ScanType ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2ScanType string
const ( Mpeg2ScanTypeInterlaced Mpeg2ScanType = "INTERLACED" Mpeg2ScanTypeProgressive Mpeg2ScanType = "PROGRESSIVE" )
Enum values for Mpeg2ScanType
func (Mpeg2ScanType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mpeg2ScanType) Values() []Mpeg2ScanType
Values returns all known values for Mpeg2ScanType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Mpeg2Settings ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2Settings struct { // description": "The framerate denominator. For example, 1001. The framerate is // the numerator divided by the denominator. For example, 24000 / 1001 = 23.976 // FPS. // // This member is required. FramerateDenominator int32 // The framerate numerator. For example, 24000. The framerate is the numerator // divided by the denominator. For example, 24000 / 1001 = 23.976 FPS. // // This member is required. FramerateNumerator int32 // Choose Off to disable adaptive quantization. Or choose another value to enable // the quantizer and set its strength. The strengths are: Auto, Off, Low, Medium, // High. When you enable this field, MediaLive allows intra-frame quantizers to // vary, which might improve visual quality. AdaptiveQuantization Mpeg2AdaptiveQuantization // Indicates the AFD values that MediaLive will write into the video encode. If you // do not know what AFD signaling is, or if your downstream system has not given // you guidance, choose AUTO. AUTO: MediaLive will try to preserve the input AFD // value (in cases where multiple AFD values are valid). FIXED: MediaLive will use // the value you specify in fixedAFD. AfdSignaling AfdSignaling // Specifies whether to include the color space metadata. The metadata describes // the color space that applies to the video (the colorSpace field). We recommend // that you insert the metadata. ColorMetadata Mpeg2ColorMetadata // Choose the type of color space conversion to apply to the output. For detailed // information on setting up both the input and the output to obtain the desired // color space in the output, see the section on "MediaLive Features - Video - // color space" in the MediaLive User Guide. PASSTHROUGH: Keep the color space of // the input content - do not convert it. AUTO:Convert all content that is SD to // rec 601, and convert all content that is HD to rec 709. ColorSpace Mpeg2ColorSpace // Sets the pixel aspect ratio for the encode. DisplayAspectRatio Mpeg2DisplayRatio // Optionally specify a noise reduction filter, which can improve quality of // compressed content. If you do not choose a filter, no filter will be applied. // TEMPORAL: This filter is useful for both source content that is noisy (when it // has excessive digital artifacts) and source content that is clean. When the // content is noisy, the filter cleans up the source content before the encoding // phase, with these two effects: First, it improves the output video quality // because the content has been cleaned up. Secondly, it decreases the bandwidth // because MediaLive does not waste bits on encoding noise. When the content is // reasonably clean, the filter tends to decrease the bitrate. FilterSettings *Mpeg2FilterSettings // Complete this field only when afdSignaling is set to FIXED. Enter the AFD value // (4 bits) to write on all frames of the video encode. FixedAfd FixedAfd // MPEG2: default is open GOP. GopClosedCadence int32 // Relates to the GOP structure. The number of B-frames between reference frames. // If you do not know what a B-frame is, use the default. GopNumBFrames int32 // Relates to the GOP structure. The GOP size (keyframe interval) in the units // specified in gopSizeUnits. If you do not know what GOP is, use the default. If // gopSizeUnits is frames, then the gopSize must be an integer and must be greater // than or equal to 1. If gopSizeUnits is seconds, the gopSize must be greater than // 0, but does not need to be an integer. GopSize float64 // Relates to the GOP structure. Specifies whether the gopSize is specified in // frames or seconds. If you do not plan to change the default gopSize, leave the // default. If you specify SECONDS, MediaLive will internally convert the gop size // to a frame count. GopSizeUnits Mpeg2GopSizeUnits // Set the scan type of the output to PROGRESSIVE or INTERLACED (top field first). ScanType Mpeg2ScanType // Relates to the GOP structure. If you do not know what GOP is, use the default. // FIXED: Set the number of B-frames in each sub-GOP to the value in gopNumBFrames. // DYNAMIC: Let MediaLive optimize the number of B-frames in each sub-GOP, to // improve visual quality. SubgopLength Mpeg2SubGopLength // Determines how MediaLive inserts timecodes in the output video. For detailed // information about setting up the input and the output for a timecode, see the // section on "MediaLive Features - Timecode configuration" in the MediaLive User // Guide. DISABLED: do not include timecodes. GOP_TIMECODE: Include timecode // metadata in the GOP header. TimecodeInsertion Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior }
Mpeg2 Settings
type Mpeg2SubGopLength ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2SubGopLength string
const ( Mpeg2SubGopLengthDynamic Mpeg2SubGopLength = "DYNAMIC" Mpeg2SubGopLengthFixed Mpeg2SubGopLength = "FIXED" )
Enum values for Mpeg2SubGopLength
func (Mpeg2SubGopLength) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mpeg2SubGopLength) Values() []Mpeg2SubGopLength
Values returns all known values for Mpeg2SubGopLength. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior ¶ added in v0.29.0
type Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior string
const ( Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehaviorDisabled Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior = "DISABLED" Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehaviorGopTimecode Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior = "GOP_TIMECODE" )
Enum values for Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior
func (Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior) Values() []Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior
Values returns all known values for Mpeg2TimecodeInsertionBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type MsSmoothGroupSettings ¶
type MsSmoothGroupSettings struct { // Smooth Streaming publish point on an IIS server. Elemental Live acts as a "Push" // encoder to IIS. // // This member is required. Destination *OutputLocationRef // The ID to include in each message in the sparse track. Ignored if // sparseTrackType is NONE. AcquisitionPointId *string // If set to passthrough for an audio-only MS Smooth output, the fragment absolute // time will be set to the current timecode. This option does not write timecodes // to the audio elementary stream. AudioOnlyTimecodeControl SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl // If set to verifyAuthenticity, verify the https certificate chain to a trusted // Certificate Authority (CA). This will cause https outputs to self-signed // certificates to fail. CertificateMode SmoothGroupCertificateMode // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the IIS server if the // connection is lost. Content will be cached during this time and the cache will // be be delivered to the IIS server once the connection is re-established. ConnectionRetryInterval int32 // MS Smooth event ID to be sent to the IIS server. Should only be specified if // eventIdMode is set to useConfigured. EventId *string // Specifies whether or not to send an event ID to the IIS server. If no event ID // is sent and the same Live Event is used without changing the publishing point, // clients might see cached video from the previous run. Options: // // * // "useConfigured" - use the value provided in eventId // // * "useTimestamp" - generate // and send an event ID based on the current timestamp // // * "noEventId" - do not send // an event ID to the IIS server. EventIdMode SmoothGroupEventIdMode // When set to sendEos, send EOS signal to IIS server when stopping the event EventStopBehavior SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration int32 // Length of mp4 fragments to generate (in seconds). Fragment length must be // compatible with GOP size and framerate. FragmentLength int32 // Parameter that control output group behavior on input loss. InputLossAction InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut // Number of retry attempts. NumRetries int32 // Number of seconds before initiating a restart due to output failure, due to // exhausting the numRetries on one segment, or exceeding filecacheDuration. RestartDelay int32 // useInputSegmentation has been deprecated. The configured segment size is always // used. SegmentationMode SmoothGroupSegmentationMode // Number of milliseconds to delay the output from the second pipeline. SendDelayMs int32 // Identifies the type of data to place in the sparse track: // // * SCTE35: Insert // SCTE-35 messages from the source content. With each message, insert an IDR frame // to start a new segment. // // * SCTE35_WITHOUT_SEGMENTATION: Insert SCTE-35 messages // from the source content. With each message, insert an IDR frame but don't start // a new segment. // // * NONE: Don't generate a sparse track for any outputs in this // output group. SparseTrackType SmoothGroupSparseTrackType // When set to send, send stream manifest so publishing point doesn't start until // all streams start. StreamManifestBehavior SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior // Timestamp offset for the event. Only used if timestampOffsetMode is set to // useConfiguredOffset. TimestampOffset *string // Type of timestamp date offset to use. // // * useEventStartDate: Use the date the // event was started as the offset // // * useConfiguredOffset: Use an explicitly // configured date as the offset TimestampOffsetMode SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode }
Ms Smooth Group Settings
type MsSmoothH265PackagingType ¶
type MsSmoothH265PackagingType string
const ( MsSmoothH265PackagingTypeHev1 MsSmoothH265PackagingType = "HEV1" MsSmoothH265PackagingTypeHvc1 MsSmoothH265PackagingType = "HVC1" )
Enum values for MsSmoothH265PackagingType
func (MsSmoothH265PackagingType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (MsSmoothH265PackagingType) Values() []MsSmoothH265PackagingType
Values returns all known values for MsSmoothH265PackagingType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type MsSmoothOutputSettings ¶
type MsSmoothOutputSettings struct { // Only applicable when this output is referencing an H.265 video description. // Specifies whether MP4 segments should be packaged as HEV1 or HVC1. H265PackagingType MsSmoothH265PackagingType // String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Required for // multiple outputs of the same type. NameModifier *string }
Ms Smooth Output Settings
type Multiplex ¶
type Multiplex struct { // The unique arn of the multiplex. Arn *string // A list of availability zones for the multiplex. AvailabilityZones []string // A list of the multiplex output destinations. Destinations []MultiplexOutputDestination // The unique id of the multiplex. Id *string // Configuration for a multiplex event. MultiplexSettings *MultiplexSettings // The name of the multiplex. Name *string // The number of currently healthy pipelines. PipelinesRunningCount int32 // The number of programs in the multiplex. ProgramCount int32 // The current state of the multiplex. State MultiplexState // A collection of key-value pairs. Tags map[string]string }
The multiplex object.
type MultiplexMediaConnectOutputDestinationSettings ¶
type MultiplexMediaConnectOutputDestinationSettings struct { // The MediaConnect entitlement ARN available as a Flow source. EntitlementArn *string }
Multiplex MediaConnect output destination settings.
type MultiplexOutputDestination ¶
type MultiplexOutputDestination struct { // Multiplex MediaConnect output destination settings. MediaConnectSettings *MultiplexMediaConnectOutputDestinationSettings }
Multiplex output destination settings
type MultiplexOutputSettings ¶
type MultiplexOutputSettings struct { // Destination is a Multiplex. // // This member is required. Destination *OutputLocationRef }
Multiplex Output Settings
type MultiplexProgram ¶
type MultiplexProgram struct { // The MediaLive channel associated with the program. ChannelId *string // The settings for this multiplex program. MultiplexProgramSettings *MultiplexProgramSettings // The packet identifier map for this multiplex program. PacketIdentifiersMap *MultiplexProgramPacketIdentifiersMap // Contains information about the current sources for the specified program in the // specified multiplex. Keep in mind that each multiplex pipeline connects to both // pipelines in a given source channel (the channel identified by the program). But // only one of those channel pipelines is ever active at one time. PipelineDetails []MultiplexProgramPipelineDetail // The name of the multiplex program. ProgramName *string }
The multiplex program object.
type MultiplexProgramChannelDestinationSettings ¶
type MultiplexProgramChannelDestinationSettings struct { // The ID of the Multiplex that the encoder is providing output to. You do not need // to specify the individual inputs to the Multiplex; MediaLive will handle the // connection of the two MediaLive pipelines to the two Multiplex instances. The // Multiplex must be in the same region as the Channel. MultiplexId *string // The program name of the Multiplex program that the encoder is providing output // to. ProgramName *string }
Multiplex Program Input Destination Settings for outputting a Channel to a Multiplex
type MultiplexProgramPacketIdentifiersMap ¶
type MultiplexProgramPacketIdentifiersMap struct { // Placeholder documentation for __listOf__integer AudioPids []int32 // Placeholder documentation for __listOf__integer DvbSubPids []int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer DvbTeletextPid int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer EtvPlatformPid int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer EtvSignalPid int32 // Placeholder documentation for __listOf__integer KlvDataPids []int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer PcrPid int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer PmtPid int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer PrivateMetadataPid int32 // Placeholder documentation for __listOf__integer Scte27Pids []int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer Scte35Pid int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer TimedMetadataPid int32 // Placeholder documentation for __integer VideoPid int32 }
Packet identifiers map for a given Multiplex program.
type MultiplexProgramPipelineDetail ¶ added in v0.29.0
type MultiplexProgramPipelineDetail struct { // Identifies the channel pipeline that is currently active for the pipeline // (identified by PipelineId) in the multiplex. ActiveChannelPipeline *string // Identifies a specific pipeline in the multiplex. PipelineId *string }
The current source for one of the pipelines in the multiplex.
type MultiplexProgramServiceDescriptor ¶
type MultiplexProgramServiceDescriptor struct { // Name of the provider. // // This member is required. ProviderName *string // Name of the service. // // This member is required. ServiceName *string }
Transport stream service descriptor configuration for the Multiplex program.
type MultiplexProgramSettings ¶
type MultiplexProgramSettings struct { // Unique program number. // // This member is required. ProgramNumber int32 // Indicates which pipeline is preferred by the multiplex for program ingest. PreferredChannelPipeline PreferredChannelPipeline // Transport stream service descriptor configuration for the Multiplex program. ServiceDescriptor *MultiplexProgramServiceDescriptor // Program video settings configuration. VideoSettings *MultiplexVideoSettings }
Multiplex Program settings configuration.
type MultiplexProgramSummary ¶
type MultiplexProgramSummary struct { // The MediaLive Channel associated with the program. ChannelId *string // The name of the multiplex program. ProgramName *string }
Placeholder documentation for MultiplexProgramSummary
type MultiplexSettings ¶
type MultiplexSettings struct { // Transport stream bit rate. // // This member is required. TransportStreamBitrate int32 // Transport stream ID. // // This member is required. TransportStreamId int32 // Maximum video buffer delay in milliseconds. MaximumVideoBufferDelayMilliseconds int32 // Transport stream reserved bit rate. TransportStreamReservedBitrate int32 }
Contains configuration for a Multiplex event
type MultiplexSettingsSummary ¶
type MultiplexSettingsSummary struct { // Transport stream bit rate. TransportStreamBitrate int32 }
Contains summary configuration for a Multiplex event.
type MultiplexState ¶
type MultiplexState string
const ( MultiplexStateCreating MultiplexState = "CREATING" MultiplexStateCreateFailed MultiplexState = "CREATE_FAILED" MultiplexStateIdle MultiplexState = "IDLE" MultiplexStateStarting MultiplexState = "STARTING" MultiplexStateRunning MultiplexState = "RUNNING" MultiplexStateRecovering MultiplexState = "RECOVERING" MultiplexStateStopping MultiplexState = "STOPPING" MultiplexStateDeleting MultiplexState = "DELETING" MultiplexStateDeleted MultiplexState = "DELETED" )
Enum values for MultiplexState
func (MultiplexState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (MultiplexState) Values() []MultiplexState
Values returns all known values for MultiplexState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type MultiplexStatmuxVideoSettings ¶
type MultiplexStatmuxVideoSettings struct { // Maximum statmux bitrate. MaximumBitrate int32 // Minimum statmux bitrate. MinimumBitrate int32 // The purpose of the priority is to use a combination of the\nmultiplex rate // control algorithm and the QVBR capability of the\nencoder to prioritize the // video quality of some channels in a\nmultiplex over others. Channels that have a // higher priority will\nget higher video quality at the expense of the video // quality of\nother channels in the multiplex with lower priority. Priority int32 }
Statmux rate control settings
type MultiplexSummary ¶
type MultiplexSummary struct { // The unique arn of the multiplex. Arn *string // A list of availability zones for the multiplex. AvailabilityZones []string // The unique id of the multiplex. Id *string // Configuration for a multiplex event. MultiplexSettings *MultiplexSettingsSummary // The name of the multiplex. Name *string // The number of currently healthy pipelines. PipelinesRunningCount int32 // The number of programs in the multiplex. ProgramCount int32 // The current state of the multiplex. State MultiplexState // A collection of key-value pairs. Tags map[string]string }
Placeholder documentation for MultiplexSummary
type MultiplexVideoSettings ¶
type MultiplexVideoSettings struct { // The constant bitrate configuration for the video encode. When this field is // defined, StatmuxSettings must be undefined. ConstantBitrate int32 // Statmux rate control settings. When this field is defined, ConstantBitrate must // be undefined. StatmuxSettings *MultiplexStatmuxVideoSettings }
The video configuration for each program in a multiplex.
type NetworkInputServerValidation ¶
type NetworkInputServerValidation string
const ( NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyAndValidateName NetworkInputServerValidation = "CHECK_CRYPTOGRAPHY_AND_VALIDATE_NAME" NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyOnly NetworkInputServerValidation = "CHECK_CRYPTOGRAPHY_ONLY" )
Enum values for NetworkInputServerValidation
func (NetworkInputServerValidation) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (NetworkInputServerValidation) Values() []NetworkInputServerValidation
Values returns all known values for NetworkInputServerValidation. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type NetworkInputSettings ¶
type NetworkInputSettings struct { // Specifies HLS input settings when the uri is for a HLS manifest. HlsInputSettings *HlsInputSettings // Check HTTPS server certificates. When set to checkCryptographyOnly, cryptography // in the certificate will be checked, but not the server's name. Certain // subdomains (notably S3 buckets that use dots in the bucket name) do not strictly // match the corresponding certificate's wildcard pattern and would otherwise cause // the event to error. This setting is ignored for protocols that do not use https. ServerValidation NetworkInputServerValidation }
Network source to transcode. Must be accessible to the Elemental Live node that is running the live event through a network connection.
type NielsenConfiguration ¶
type NielsenConfiguration struct { // Enter the Distributor ID assigned to your organization by Nielsen. DistributorId *string // Enables Nielsen PCM to ID3 tagging NielsenPcmToId3Tagging NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState }
Nielsen Configuration
type NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState ¶
type NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState string
const ( NielsenPcmToId3TaggingStateDisabled NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState = "DISABLED" NielsenPcmToId3TaggingStateEnabled NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState
func (NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState) Values() []NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState
Values returns all known values for NielsenPcmToId3TaggingState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type NotFoundException ¶
type NotFoundException struct {
Message *string
}
Placeholder documentation for NotFoundException
func (*NotFoundException) Error ¶
func (e *NotFoundException) Error() string
func (*NotFoundException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *NotFoundException) ErrorCode() string
func (*NotFoundException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *NotFoundException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*NotFoundException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *NotFoundException) ErrorMessage() string
type Offering ¶
type Offering struct { // Unique offering ARN, e.g. // 'arn:aws:medialive:us-west-2:123456789012:offering:87654321' Arn *string // Currency code for usagePrice and fixedPrice in ISO-4217 format, e.g. 'USD' CurrencyCode *string // Lease duration, e.g. '12' Duration int32 // Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS' DurationUnits OfferingDurationUnits // One-time charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '0.0' for a NO_UPFRONT offering FixedPrice float64 // Offering description, e.g. 'HD AVC output at 10-20 Mbps, 30 fps, and standard VQ // in US West (Oregon)' OfferingDescription *string // Unique offering ID, e.g. '87654321' OfferingId *string // Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT' OfferingType OfferingType // AWS region, e.g. 'us-west-2' Region *string // Resource configuration details ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification // Recurring usage charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '157.0' UsagePrice float64 }
Reserved resources available for purchase
type OfferingDurationUnits ¶
type OfferingDurationUnits string
const (
OfferingDurationUnitsMonths OfferingDurationUnits = "MONTHS"
)
Enum values for OfferingDurationUnits
func (OfferingDurationUnits) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (OfferingDurationUnits) Values() []OfferingDurationUnits
Values returns all known values for OfferingDurationUnits. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type OfferingType ¶
type OfferingType string
const (
OfferingTypeNoUpfront OfferingType = "NO_UPFRONT"
)
Enum values for OfferingType
func (OfferingType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (OfferingType) Values() []OfferingType
Values returns all known values for OfferingType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Output ¶
type Output struct { // Output type-specific settings. // // This member is required. OutputSettings *OutputSettings // The names of the AudioDescriptions used as audio sources for this output. AudioDescriptionNames []string // The names of the CaptionDescriptions used as caption sources for this output. CaptionDescriptionNames []string // The name used to identify an output. OutputName *string // The name of the VideoDescription used as the source for this output. VideoDescriptionName *string }
Output settings. There can be multiple outputs within a group.
type OutputDestination ¶
type OutputDestination struct { // User-specified id. This is used in an output group or an output. Id *string // Destination settings for a MediaPackage output; one destination for both // encoders. MediaPackageSettings []MediaPackageOutputDestinationSettings // Destination settings for a Multiplex output; one destination for both encoders. MultiplexSettings *MultiplexProgramChannelDestinationSettings // Destination settings for a standard output; one destination for each redundant // encoder. Settings []OutputDestinationSettings }
Placeholder documentation for OutputDestination
type OutputDestinationSettings ¶
type OutputDestinationSettings struct { // key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store PasswordParam *string // Stream name for RTMP destinations (URLs of type rtmp://) StreamName *string // A URL specifying a destination Url *string // username for destination Username *string }
Placeholder documentation for OutputDestinationSettings
type OutputGroup ¶
type OutputGroup struct { // Settings associated with the output group. // // This member is required. OutputGroupSettings *OutputGroupSettings // Placeholder documentation for __listOfOutput // // This member is required. Outputs []Output // Custom output group name optionally defined by the user. Only letters, numbers, // and the underscore character allowed; only 32 characters allowed. Name *string }
Output groups for this Live Event. Output groups contain information about where streams should be distributed.
type OutputGroupSettings ¶
type OutputGroupSettings struct { // Archive Group Settings ArchiveGroupSettings *ArchiveGroupSettings // Frame Capture Group Settings FrameCaptureGroupSettings *FrameCaptureGroupSettings // Hls Group Settings HlsGroupSettings *HlsGroupSettings // Media Package Group Settings MediaPackageGroupSettings *MediaPackageGroupSettings // Ms Smooth Group Settings MsSmoothGroupSettings *MsSmoothGroupSettings // Multiplex Group Settings MultiplexGroupSettings *MultiplexGroupSettings // Rtmp Group Settings RtmpGroupSettings *RtmpGroupSettings // Udp Group Settings UdpGroupSettings *UdpGroupSettings }
Output Group Settings
type OutputLocationRef ¶
type OutputLocationRef struct { // Placeholder documentation for __string DestinationRefId *string }
Reference to an OutputDestination ID defined in the channel
type OutputSettings ¶
type OutputSettings struct { // Archive Output Settings ArchiveOutputSettings *ArchiveOutputSettings // Frame Capture Output Settings FrameCaptureOutputSettings *FrameCaptureOutputSettings // Hls Output Settings HlsOutputSettings *HlsOutputSettings // Media Package Output Settings MediaPackageOutputSettings *MediaPackageOutputSettings // Ms Smooth Output Settings MsSmoothOutputSettings *MsSmoothOutputSettings // Multiplex Output Settings MultiplexOutputSettings *MultiplexOutputSettings // Rtmp Output Settings RtmpOutputSettings *RtmpOutputSettings // Udp Output Settings UdpOutputSettings *UdpOutputSettings }
Output Settings
type PauseStateScheduleActionSettings ¶
type PauseStateScheduleActionSettings struct { // Placeholder documentation for __listOfPipelinePauseStateSettings Pipelines []PipelinePauseStateSettings }
Settings for the action to set pause state of a channel.
type PipelineDetail ¶
type PipelineDetail struct { // The name of the active input attachment currently being ingested by this // pipeline. ActiveInputAttachmentName *string // The name of the input switch schedule action that occurred most recently and // that resulted in the switch to the current input attachment for this pipeline. ActiveInputSwitchActionName *string // The name of the motion graphics activate action that occurred most recently and // that resulted in the current graphics URI for this pipeline. ActiveMotionGraphicsActionName *string // The current URI being used for HTML5 motion graphics for this pipeline. ActiveMotionGraphicsUri *string // Pipeline ID PipelineId *string }
Runtime details of a pipeline when a channel is running.
type PipelineId ¶
type PipelineId string
const ( PipelineIdPipeline0 PipelineId = "PIPELINE_0" PipelineIdPipeline1 PipelineId = "PIPELINE_1" )
Enum values for PipelineId
func (PipelineId) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (PipelineId) Values() []PipelineId
Values returns all known values for PipelineId. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type PipelinePauseStateSettings ¶
type PipelinePauseStateSettings struct { // Pipeline ID to pause ("PIPELINE_0" or "PIPELINE_1"). // // This member is required. PipelineId PipelineId }
Settings for pausing a pipeline.
type PreferredChannelPipeline ¶
type PreferredChannelPipeline string
const ( PreferredChannelPipelineCurrentlyActive PreferredChannelPipeline = "CURRENTLY_ACTIVE" PreferredChannelPipelinePipeline0 PreferredChannelPipeline = "PIPELINE_0" PreferredChannelPipelinePipeline1 PreferredChannelPipeline = "PIPELINE_1" )
Enum values for PreferredChannelPipeline
func (PreferredChannelPipeline) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (PreferredChannelPipeline) Values() []PreferredChannelPipeline
Values returns all known values for PreferredChannelPipeline. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type RemixSettings ¶
type RemixSettings struct { // Mapping of input channels to output channels, with appropriate gain adjustments. // // This member is required. ChannelMappings []AudioChannelMapping // Number of input channels to be used. ChannelsIn int32 // Number of output channels to be produced. Valid values: 1, 2, 4, 6, 8 ChannelsOut int32 }
Remix Settings
type Reservation ¶
type Reservation struct { // Unique reservation ARN, e.g. // 'arn:aws:medialive:us-west-2:123456789012:reservation:1234567' Arn *string // Number of reserved resources Count int32 // Currency code for usagePrice and fixedPrice in ISO-4217 format, e.g. 'USD' CurrencyCode *string // Lease duration, e.g. '12' Duration int32 // Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS' DurationUnits OfferingDurationUnits // Reservation UTC end date and time in ISO-8601 format, e.g. '2019-03-01T00:00:00' End *string // One-time charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '0.0' for a NO_UPFRONT offering FixedPrice float64 // User specified reservation name Name *string // Offering description, e.g. 'HD AVC output at 10-20 Mbps, 30 fps, and standard VQ // in US West (Oregon)' OfferingDescription *string // Unique offering ID, e.g. '87654321' OfferingId *string // Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT' OfferingType OfferingType // AWS region, e.g. 'us-west-2' Region *string // Unique reservation ID, e.g. '1234567' ReservationId *string // Resource configuration details ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification // Reservation UTC start date and time in ISO-8601 format, e.g. // '2018-03-01T00:00:00' Start *string // Current state of reservation, e.g. 'ACTIVE' State ReservationState // A collection of key-value pairs Tags map[string]string // Recurring usage charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '157.0' UsagePrice float64 }
Reserved resources available to use
type ReservationCodec ¶
type ReservationCodec string
const ( ReservationCodecMpeg2 ReservationCodec = "MPEG2" ReservationCodecAvc ReservationCodec = "AVC" ReservationCodecHevc ReservationCodec = "HEVC" ReservationCodecAudio ReservationCodec = "AUDIO" ReservationCodecLink ReservationCodec = "LINK" )
Enum values for ReservationCodec
func (ReservationCodec) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ReservationCodec) Values() []ReservationCodec
Values returns all known values for ReservationCodec. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ReservationMaximumBitrate ¶
type ReservationMaximumBitrate string
const ( ReservationMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps ReservationMaximumBitrate = "MAX_10_MBPS" ReservationMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps ReservationMaximumBitrate = "MAX_20_MBPS" ReservationMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps ReservationMaximumBitrate = "MAX_50_MBPS" )
Enum values for ReservationMaximumBitrate
func (ReservationMaximumBitrate) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ReservationMaximumBitrate) Values() []ReservationMaximumBitrate
Values returns all known values for ReservationMaximumBitrate. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ReservationMaximumFramerate ¶
type ReservationMaximumFramerate string
const ( ReservationMaximumFramerateMax30Fps ReservationMaximumFramerate = "MAX_30_FPS" ReservationMaximumFramerateMax60Fps ReservationMaximumFramerate = "MAX_60_FPS" )
Enum values for ReservationMaximumFramerate
func (ReservationMaximumFramerate) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ReservationMaximumFramerate) Values() []ReservationMaximumFramerate
Values returns all known values for ReservationMaximumFramerate. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ReservationResolution ¶
type ReservationResolution string
const ( ReservationResolutionSd ReservationResolution = "SD" ReservationResolutionHd ReservationResolution = "HD" ReservationResolutionFhd ReservationResolution = "FHD" ReservationResolutionUhd ReservationResolution = "UHD" )
Enum values for ReservationResolution
func (ReservationResolution) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ReservationResolution) Values() []ReservationResolution
Values returns all known values for ReservationResolution. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ReservationResourceSpecification ¶
type ReservationResourceSpecification struct { // Channel class, e.g. 'STANDARD' ChannelClass ChannelClass // Codec, e.g. 'AVC' Codec ReservationCodec // Maximum bitrate, e.g. 'MAX_20_MBPS' MaximumBitrate ReservationMaximumBitrate // Maximum framerate, e.g. 'MAX_30_FPS' (Outputs only) MaximumFramerate ReservationMaximumFramerate // Resolution, e.g. 'HD' Resolution ReservationResolution // Resource type, 'INPUT', 'OUTPUT', 'MULTIPLEX', or 'CHANNEL' ResourceType ReservationResourceType // Special feature, e.g. 'AUDIO_NORMALIZATION' (Channels only) SpecialFeature ReservationSpecialFeature // Video quality, e.g. 'STANDARD' (Outputs only) VideoQuality ReservationVideoQuality }
Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...)
type ReservationResourceType ¶
type ReservationResourceType string
const ( ReservationResourceTypeInput ReservationResourceType = "INPUT" ReservationResourceTypeOutput ReservationResourceType = "OUTPUT" ReservationResourceTypeMultiplex ReservationResourceType = "MULTIPLEX" ReservationResourceTypeChannel ReservationResourceType = "CHANNEL" )
Enum values for ReservationResourceType
func (ReservationResourceType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ReservationResourceType) Values() []ReservationResourceType
Values returns all known values for ReservationResourceType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ReservationSpecialFeature ¶
type ReservationSpecialFeature string
const ( ReservationSpecialFeatureAdvancedAudio ReservationSpecialFeature = "ADVANCED_AUDIO" ReservationSpecialFeatureAudioNormalization ReservationSpecialFeature = "AUDIO_NORMALIZATION" )
Enum values for ReservationSpecialFeature
func (ReservationSpecialFeature) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ReservationSpecialFeature) Values() []ReservationSpecialFeature
Values returns all known values for ReservationSpecialFeature. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ReservationState ¶
type ReservationState string
const ( ReservationStateActive ReservationState = "ACTIVE" ReservationStateExpired ReservationState = "EXPIRED" ReservationStateCanceled ReservationState = "CANCELED" ReservationStateDeleted ReservationState = "DELETED" )
Enum values for ReservationState
func (ReservationState) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ReservationState) Values() []ReservationState
Values returns all known values for ReservationState. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ReservationVideoQuality ¶
type ReservationVideoQuality string
const ( ReservationVideoQualityStandard ReservationVideoQuality = "STANDARD" ReservationVideoQualityEnhanced ReservationVideoQuality = "ENHANCED" ReservationVideoQualityPremium ReservationVideoQuality = "PREMIUM" )
Enum values for ReservationVideoQuality
func (ReservationVideoQuality) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (ReservationVideoQuality) Values() []ReservationVideoQuality
Values returns all known values for ReservationVideoQuality. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type RtmpAdMarkers ¶ added in v0.30.0
type RtmpAdMarkers string
const (
RtmpAdMarkersOnCuePointScte35 RtmpAdMarkers = "ON_CUE_POINT_SCTE35"
)
Enum values for RtmpAdMarkers
func (RtmpAdMarkers) Values ¶ added in v0.30.0
func (RtmpAdMarkers) Values() []RtmpAdMarkers
Values returns all known values for RtmpAdMarkers. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type RtmpCacheFullBehavior ¶
type RtmpCacheFullBehavior string
const ( RtmpCacheFullBehaviorDisconnectImmediately RtmpCacheFullBehavior = "DISCONNECT_IMMEDIATELY" RtmpCacheFullBehaviorWaitForServer RtmpCacheFullBehavior = "WAIT_FOR_SERVER" )
Enum values for RtmpCacheFullBehavior
func (RtmpCacheFullBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (RtmpCacheFullBehavior) Values() []RtmpCacheFullBehavior
Values returns all known values for RtmpCacheFullBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type RtmpCaptionData ¶
type RtmpCaptionData string
const ( RtmpCaptionDataAll RtmpCaptionData = "ALL" RtmpCaptionDataField1608 RtmpCaptionData = "FIELD1_608" RtmpCaptionDataField1AndField2608 RtmpCaptionData = "FIELD1_AND_FIELD2_608" )
Enum values for RtmpCaptionData
func (RtmpCaptionData) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (RtmpCaptionData) Values() []RtmpCaptionData
Values returns all known values for RtmpCaptionData. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings ¶
type RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings struct { }
Rtmp Caption Info Destination Settings
type RtmpGroupSettings ¶
type RtmpGroupSettings struct { // Choose the ad marker type for this output group. MediaLive will create a message // based on the content of each SCTE-35 message, format it for that marker type, // and insert it in the datastream. AdMarkers []RtmpAdMarkers // Authentication scheme to use when connecting with CDN AuthenticationScheme AuthenticationScheme // Controls behavior when content cache fills up. If remote origin server stalls // the RTMP connection and does not accept content fast enough the 'Media Cache' // will fill up. When the cache reaches the duration specified by cacheLength the // cache will stop accepting new content. If set to disconnectImmediately, the RTMP // output will force a disconnect. Clear the media cache, and reconnect after // restartDelay seconds. If set to waitForServer, the RTMP output will wait up to 5 // minutes to allow the origin server to begin accepting data again. CacheFullBehavior RtmpCacheFullBehavior // Cache length, in seconds, is used to calculate buffer size. CacheLength int32 // Controls the types of data that passes to onCaptionInfo outputs. If set to 'all' // then 608 and 708 carried DTVCC data will be passed. If set to // 'field1AndField2608' then DTVCC data will be stripped out, but 608 data from // both fields will be passed. If set to 'field1608' then only the data carried in // 608 from field 1 video will be passed. CaptionData RtmpCaptionData // Controls the behavior of this RTMP group if input becomes unavailable. // // * // emitOutput: Emit a slate until input returns. // // * pauseOutput: Stop transmitting // data until input returns. This does not close the underlying RTMP connection. InputLossAction InputLossActionForRtmpOut // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay int32 }
Rtmp Group Settings
type RtmpOutputCertificateMode ¶
type RtmpOutputCertificateMode string
const ( RtmpOutputCertificateModeSelfSigned RtmpOutputCertificateMode = "SELF_SIGNED" RtmpOutputCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity RtmpOutputCertificateMode = "VERIFY_AUTHENTICITY" )
Enum values for RtmpOutputCertificateMode
func (RtmpOutputCertificateMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (RtmpOutputCertificateMode) Values() []RtmpOutputCertificateMode
Values returns all known values for RtmpOutputCertificateMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type RtmpOutputSettings ¶
type RtmpOutputSettings struct { // The RTMP endpoint excluding the stream name (eg. rtmp://host/appname). For // connection to Akamai, a username and password must be supplied. URI fields // accept format identifiers. // // This member is required. Destination *OutputLocationRef // If set to verifyAuthenticity, verify the tls certificate chain to a trusted // Certificate Authority (CA). This will cause rtmps outputs with self-signed // certificates to fail. CertificateMode RtmpOutputCertificateMode // Number of seconds to wait before retrying a connection to the Flash Media server // if the connection is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval int32 // Number of retry attempts. NumRetries int32 }
Rtmp Output Settings
type S3CannedAcl ¶ added in v1.2.0
type S3CannedAcl string
const ( S3CannedAclAuthenticatedRead S3CannedAcl = "AUTHENTICATED_READ" S3CannedAclBucketOwnerFullControl S3CannedAcl = "BUCKET_OWNER_FULL_CONTROL" S3CannedAclBucketOwnerRead S3CannedAcl = "BUCKET_OWNER_READ" S3CannedAclPublicRead S3CannedAcl = "PUBLIC_READ" )
Enum values for S3CannedAcl
func (S3CannedAcl) Values ¶ added in v1.2.0
func (S3CannedAcl) Values() []S3CannedAcl
Values returns all known values for S3CannedAcl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type ScheduleAction ¶
type ScheduleAction struct { // The name of the action, must be unique within the schedule. This name provides // the main reference to an action once it is added to the schedule. A name is // unique if it is no longer in the schedule. The schedule is automatically cleaned // up to remove actions with a start time of more than 1 hour ago (approximately) // so at that point a name can be reused. // // This member is required. ActionName *string // Settings for this schedule action. // // This member is required. ScheduleActionSettings *ScheduleActionSettings // The time for the action to start in the channel. // // This member is required. ScheduleActionStartSettings *ScheduleActionStartSettings }
Contains information on a single schedule action.
type ScheduleActionSettings ¶
type ScheduleActionSettings struct { // Action to insert HLS ID3 segment tagging HlsId3SegmentTaggingSettings *HlsId3SegmentTaggingScheduleActionSettings // Action to insert HLS metadata HlsTimedMetadataSettings *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings // Action to prepare an input for a future immediate input switch InputPrepareSettings *InputPrepareScheduleActionSettings // Action to switch the input InputSwitchSettings *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings // Action to activate a motion graphics image overlay MotionGraphicsImageActivateSettings *MotionGraphicsActivateScheduleActionSettings // Action to deactivate a motion graphics image overlay MotionGraphicsImageDeactivateSettings *MotionGraphicsDeactivateScheduleActionSettings // Action to pause or unpause one or both channel pipelines PauseStateSettings *PauseStateScheduleActionSettings // Action to insert SCTE-35 return_to_network message Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings // Action to insert SCTE-35 splice_insert message Scte35SpliceInsertSettings *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings // Action to insert SCTE-35 time_signal message Scte35TimeSignalSettings *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings // Action to activate a static image overlay StaticImageActivateSettings *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings // Action to deactivate a static image overlay StaticImageDeactivateSettings *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings }
Holds the settings for a single schedule action.
type ScheduleActionStartSettings ¶
type ScheduleActionStartSettings struct { // Option for specifying the start time for an action. FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings // Option for specifying an action as relative to another action. FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings // Option for specifying an action that should be applied immediately. ImmediateModeScheduleActionStartSettings *ImmediateModeScheduleActionStartSettings }
Settings to specify when an action should occur. Only one of the options must be selected.
type Scte20Convert608To708 ¶
type Scte20Convert608To708 string
const ( Scte20Convert608To708Disabled Scte20Convert608To708 = "DISABLED" Scte20Convert608To708Upconvert Scte20Convert608To708 = "UPCONVERT" )
Enum values for Scte20Convert608To708
func (Scte20Convert608To708) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte20Convert608To708) Values() []Scte20Convert608To708
Values returns all known values for Scte20Convert608To708. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings ¶
type Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings struct { }
Scte20 Plus Embedded Destination Settings
type Scte20SourceSettings ¶
type Scte20SourceSettings struct { // If upconvert, 608 data is both passed through via the "608 compatibility bytes" // fields of the 708 wrapper as well as translated into 708. 708 data present in // the source content will be discarded. Convert608To708 Scte20Convert608To708 // Specifies the 608/708 channel number within the video track from which to // extract captions. Unused for passthrough. Source608ChannelNumber int32 }
Scte20 Source Settings
type Scte27DestinationSettings ¶
type Scte27DestinationSettings struct { }
Scte27 Destination Settings
type Scte27SourceSettings ¶
type Scte27SourceSettings struct { // The pid field is used in conjunction with the caption selector languageCode // field as follows: // // * Specify PID and Language: Extracts captions from that PID; // the language is "informational". // // * Specify PID and omit Language: Extracts the // specified PID. // // * Omit PID and specify Language: Extracts the specified // language, whichever PID that happens to be. // // * Omit PID and omit Language: Valid // only if source is DVB-Sub that is being passed through; all languages will be // passed through. Pid int32 }
Scte27 Source Settings
type Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior ¶
type Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior string
const ( Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior = "FOLLOW" Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior = "IGNORE" )
Enum values for Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior
func (Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior) Values() []Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior
Values returns all known values for Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior ¶
type Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior string
const ( Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior = "FOLLOW" Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior = "IGNORE" )
Enum values for Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior
func (Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior) Values() []Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior
Values returns all known values for Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag ¶
type Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag string
const ( Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveNotAllowed Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag = "ARCHIVE_NOT_ALLOWED" Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveAllowed Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag = "ARCHIVE_ALLOWED" )
Enum values for Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag
func (Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag) Values() []Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag
Values returns all known values for Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte35DeliveryRestrictions ¶
type Scte35DeliveryRestrictions struct { // Corresponds to SCTE-35 archive_allowed_flag. // // This member is required. ArchiveAllowedFlag Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag // Corresponds to SCTE-35 device_restrictions parameter. // // This member is required. DeviceRestrictions Scte35DeviceRestrictions // Corresponds to SCTE-35 no_regional_blackout_flag parameter. // // This member is required. NoRegionalBlackoutFlag Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag // Corresponds to SCTE-35 web_delivery_allowed_flag parameter. // // This member is required. WebDeliveryAllowedFlag Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag }
Corresponds to SCTE-35 delivery_not_restricted_flag parameter. To declare delivery restrictions, include this element and its four "restriction" flags. To declare that there are no restrictions, omit this element.
type Scte35Descriptor ¶
type Scte35Descriptor struct { // SCTE-35 Descriptor Settings. // // This member is required. Scte35DescriptorSettings *Scte35DescriptorSettings }
Holds one set of SCTE-35 Descriptor Settings.
type Scte35DescriptorSettings ¶
type Scte35DescriptorSettings struct { // SCTE-35 Segmentation Descriptor. // // This member is required. SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor }
SCTE-35 Descriptor settings.
type Scte35DeviceRestrictions ¶
type Scte35DeviceRestrictions string
const ( Scte35DeviceRestrictionsNone Scte35DeviceRestrictions = "NONE" Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup0 Scte35DeviceRestrictions = "RESTRICT_GROUP0" Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup1 Scte35DeviceRestrictions = "RESTRICT_GROUP1" Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup2 Scte35DeviceRestrictions = "RESTRICT_GROUP2" )
Enum values for Scte35DeviceRestrictions
func (Scte35DeviceRestrictions) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35DeviceRestrictions) Values() []Scte35DeviceRestrictions
Values returns all known values for Scte35DeviceRestrictions. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag ¶
type Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag string
const ( Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagRegionalBlackout Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag = "REGIONAL_BLACKOUT" Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagNoRegionalBlackout Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag = "NO_REGIONAL_BLACKOUT" )
Enum values for Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag
func (Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag) Values() []Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag
Values returns all known values for Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings ¶
type Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings struct { // The splice_event_id for the SCTE-35 splice_insert, as defined in SCTE-35. // // This member is required. SpliceEventId int64 }
Settings for a SCTE-35 return_to_network message.
type Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator ¶
type Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator string
const ( Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventNotCanceled Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator = "SEGMENTATION_EVENT_NOT_CANCELED" Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventCanceled Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator = "SEGMENTATION_EVENT_CANCELED" )
Enum values for Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator
func (Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator) Values() []Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator
Values returns all known values for Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte35SegmentationDescriptor ¶
type Scte35SegmentationDescriptor struct { // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_event_cancel_indicator. // // This member is required. SegmentationCancelIndicator Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_event_id. // // This member is required. SegmentationEventId int64 // Holds the four SCTE-35 delivery restriction parameters. DeliveryRestrictions *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segment_num. A value that is valid for the specified // segmentation_type_id. SegmentNum int32 // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_duration. Optional. The duration for the // time_signal, in 90 KHz ticks. To convert seconds to ticks, multiple the seconds // by 90,000. Enter time in 90 KHz clock ticks. If you do not enter a duration, the // time_signal will continue until you insert a cancellation message. SegmentationDuration int64 // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_type_id. One of the segmentation_type_id // values listed in the SCTE-35 specification. On the console, enter the ID in // decimal (for example, "52"). In the CLI, API, or an SDK, enter the ID in hex // (for example, "0x34") or decimal (for example, "52"). SegmentationTypeId int32 // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_upid. Enter a string containing the // hexadecimal representation of the characters that make up the SCTE-35 // segmentation_upid value. Must contain an even number of hex characters. Do not // include spaces between each hex pair. For example, the ASCII "ADS Information" // becomes hex "41445320496e666f726d6174696f6e. SegmentationUpid *string // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_upid_type. On the console, enter one of the // types listed in the SCTE-35 specification, converted to a decimal. For example, // "0x0C" hex from the specification is "12" in decimal. In the CLI, API, or an // SDK, enter one of the types listed in the SCTE-35 specification, in either hex // (for example, "0x0C" ) or in decimal (for example, "12"). SegmentationUpidType int32 // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segments_expected. A value that is valid for the // specified segmentation_type_id. SegmentsExpected int32 // Corresponds to SCTE-35 sub_segment_num. A value that is valid for the specified // segmentation_type_id. SubSegmentNum int32 // Corresponds to SCTE-35 sub_segments_expected. A value that is valid for the // specified segmentation_type_id. SubSegmentsExpected int32 }
Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_descriptor.
type Scte35SpliceInsert ¶
type Scte35SpliceInsert struct { // When specified, this offset (in milliseconds) is added to the input Ad Avail PTS // time. This only applies to embedded SCTE 104/35 messages and does not apply to // OOB messages. AdAvailOffset int32 // When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with noRegionalBlackoutFlag set to 0 // will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates NoRegionalBlackoutFlag Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior // When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with webDeliveryAllowedFlag set to 0 // will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates WebDeliveryAllowedFlag Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior }
Scte35 Splice Insert
type Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior ¶
type Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior string
const ( Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior = "FOLLOW" Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior = "IGNORE" )
Enum values for Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior
func (Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior) Values() []Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior
Values returns all known values for Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings ¶
type Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings struct { // The splice_event_id for the SCTE-35 splice_insert, as defined in SCTE-35. // // This member is required. SpliceEventId int64 // Optional, the duration for the splice_insert, in 90 KHz ticks. To convert // seconds to ticks, multiple the seconds by 90,000. If you enter a duration, there // is an expectation that the downstream system can read the duration and cue in at // that time. If you do not enter a duration, the splice_insert will continue // indefinitely and there is an expectation that you will enter a return_to_network // to end the splice_insert at the appropriate time. Duration int64 }
Settings for a SCTE-35 splice_insert message.
type Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior ¶
type Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior string
const ( Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior = "FOLLOW" Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior = "IGNORE" )
Enum values for Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior
func (Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior) Values() []Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior
Values returns all known values for Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Scte35TimeSignalApos ¶
type Scte35TimeSignalApos struct { // When specified, this offset (in milliseconds) is added to the input Ad Avail PTS // time. This only applies to embedded SCTE 104/35 messages and does not apply to // OOB messages. AdAvailOffset int32 // When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with noRegionalBlackoutFlag set to 0 // will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates NoRegionalBlackoutFlag Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior // When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with webDeliveryAllowedFlag set to 0 // will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates WebDeliveryAllowedFlag Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior }
Scte35 Time Signal Apos
type Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings ¶
type Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings struct { // The list of SCTE-35 descriptors accompanying the SCTE-35 time_signal. // // This member is required. Scte35Descriptors []Scte35Descriptor }
Settings for a SCTE-35 time_signal.
type Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag ¶
type Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag string
const ( Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryNotAllowed Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag = "WEB_DELIVERY_NOT_ALLOWED" Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryAllowed Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag = "WEB_DELIVERY_ALLOWED" )
Enum values for Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag
func (Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag) Values() []Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag
Values returns all known values for Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl ¶
type SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl string
const ( SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlPassthrough SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl = "PASSTHROUGH" SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlUseConfiguredClock SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl = "USE_CONFIGURED_CLOCK" )
Enum values for SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl
func (SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl) Values() []SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl
Values returns all known values for SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmoothGroupCertificateMode ¶
type SmoothGroupCertificateMode string
const ( SmoothGroupCertificateModeSelfSigned SmoothGroupCertificateMode = "SELF_SIGNED" SmoothGroupCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity SmoothGroupCertificateMode = "VERIFY_AUTHENTICITY" )
Enum values for SmoothGroupCertificateMode
func (SmoothGroupCertificateMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (SmoothGroupCertificateMode) Values() []SmoothGroupCertificateMode
Values returns all known values for SmoothGroupCertificateMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmoothGroupEventIdMode ¶
type SmoothGroupEventIdMode string
const ( SmoothGroupEventIdModeNoEventId SmoothGroupEventIdMode = "NO_EVENT_ID" SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseConfigured SmoothGroupEventIdMode = "USE_CONFIGURED" SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseTimestamp SmoothGroupEventIdMode = "USE_TIMESTAMP" )
Enum values for SmoothGroupEventIdMode
func (SmoothGroupEventIdMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (SmoothGroupEventIdMode) Values() []SmoothGroupEventIdMode
Values returns all known values for SmoothGroupEventIdMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior ¶
type SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior string
const ( SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorNone SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior = "NONE" SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorSendEos SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior = "SEND_EOS" )
Enum values for SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior
func (SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior) Values() []SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior
Values returns all known values for SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmoothGroupSegmentationMode ¶
type SmoothGroupSegmentationMode string
const ( SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation SmoothGroupSegmentationMode = "USE_INPUT_SEGMENTATION" SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration SmoothGroupSegmentationMode = "USE_SEGMENT_DURATION" )
Enum values for SmoothGroupSegmentationMode
func (SmoothGroupSegmentationMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (SmoothGroupSegmentationMode) Values() []SmoothGroupSegmentationMode
Values returns all known values for SmoothGroupSegmentationMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmoothGroupSparseTrackType ¶
type SmoothGroupSparseTrackType string
const ( SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeNone SmoothGroupSparseTrackType = "NONE" SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeScte35 SmoothGroupSparseTrackType = "SCTE_35" SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeScte35WithoutSegmentation SmoothGroupSparseTrackType = "SCTE_35_WITHOUT_SEGMENTATION" )
Enum values for SmoothGroupSparseTrackType
func (SmoothGroupSparseTrackType) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (SmoothGroupSparseTrackType) Values() []SmoothGroupSparseTrackType
Values returns all known values for SmoothGroupSparseTrackType. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior ¶
type SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior string
const ( SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorDoNotSend SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior = "DO_NOT_SEND" SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorSend SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior = "SEND" )
Enum values for SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior
func (SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior) Values() []SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior
Values returns all known values for SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode ¶
type SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode string
const ( SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseConfiguredOffset SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode = "USE_CONFIGURED_OFFSET" SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseEventStartDate SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode = "USE_EVENT_START_DATE" )
Enum values for SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode
func (SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode) Values() []SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode
Values returns all known values for SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type Smpte2038DataPreference ¶
type Smpte2038DataPreference string
const ( Smpte2038DataPreferenceIgnore Smpte2038DataPreference = "IGNORE" Smpte2038DataPreferencePrefer Smpte2038DataPreference = "PREFER" )
Enum values for Smpte2038DataPreference
func (Smpte2038DataPreference) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (Smpte2038DataPreference) Values() []Smpte2038DataPreference
Values returns all known values for Smpte2038DataPreference. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type SmpteTtDestinationSettings ¶
type SmpteTtDestinationSettings struct { }
Smpte Tt Destination Settings
type StandardHlsSettings ¶
type StandardHlsSettings struct { // Settings information for the .m3u8 container // // This member is required. M3u8Settings *M3u8Settings // List all the audio groups that are used with the video output stream. Input all // the audio GROUP-IDs that are associated to the video, separate by ','. AudioRenditionSets *string }
Standard Hls Settings
type StartTimecode ¶
type StartTimecode struct { // The timecode for the frame where you want to start the clip. Optional; if not // specified, the clip starts at first frame in the file. Enter the timecode as // HH:MM:SS:FF or HH:MM:SS;FF. Timecode *string }
Settings to identify the start of the clip.
type StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings ¶
type StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings struct { // The location and filename of the image file to overlay on the video. The file // must be a 32-bit BMP, PNG, or TGA file, and must not be larger (in pixels) than // the input video. // // This member is required. Image *InputLocation // The duration in milliseconds for the image to remain on the video. If omitted or // set to 0 the duration is unlimited and the image will remain until it is // explicitly deactivated. Duration int32 // The time in milliseconds for the image to fade in. The fade-in starts at the // start time of the overlay. Default is 0 (no fade-in). FadeIn int32 // Applies only if a duration is specified. The time in milliseconds for the image // to fade out. The fade-out starts when the duration time is hit, so it // effectively extends the duration. Default is 0 (no fade-out). FadeOut int32 // The height of the image when inserted into the video, in pixels. The overlay // will be scaled up or down to the specified height. Leave blank to use the native // height of the overlay. Height int32 // Placement of the left edge of the overlay relative to the left edge of the video // frame, in pixels. 0 (the default) is the left edge of the frame. If the // placement causes the overlay to extend beyond the right edge of the underlying // video, then the overlay is cropped on the right. ImageX int32 // Placement of the top edge of the overlay relative to the top edge of the video // frame, in pixels. 0 (the default) is the top edge of the frame. If the placement // causes the overlay to extend beyond the bottom edge of the underlying video, // then the overlay is cropped on the bottom. ImageY int32 // The number of the layer, 0 to 7. There are 8 layers that can be overlaid on the // video, each layer with a different image. The layers are in Z order, which means // that overlays with higher values of layer are inserted on top of overlays with // lower values of layer. Default is 0. Layer int32 // Opacity of image where 0 is transparent and 100 is fully opaque. Default is 100. Opacity int32 // The width of the image when inserted into the video, in pixels. The overlay will // be scaled up or down to the specified width. Leave blank to use the native width // of the overlay. Width int32 }
Settings for the action to activate a static image.
type StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings ¶
type StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings struct { // The time in milliseconds for the image to fade out. Default is 0 (no fade-out). FadeOut int32 // The image overlay layer to deactivate, 0 to 7. Default is 0. Layer int32 }
Settings for the action to deactivate the image in a specific layer.
type StaticKeySettings ¶
type StaticKeySettings struct { // Static key value as a 32 character hexadecimal string. // // This member is required. StaticKeyValue *string // The URL of the license server used for protecting content. KeyProviderServer *InputLocation }
Static Key Settings
type StopTimecode ¶
type StopTimecode struct { // If you specify a StopTimecode in an input (in order to clip the file), you can // specify if you want the clip to exclude (the default) or include the frame // specified by the timecode. LastFrameClippingBehavior LastFrameClippingBehavior // The timecode for the frame where you want to stop the clip. Optional; if not // specified, the clip continues to the end of the file. Enter the timecode as // HH:MM:SS:FF or HH:MM:SS;FF. Timecode *string }
Settings to identify the end of the clip.
type TeletextDestinationSettings ¶
type TeletextDestinationSettings struct { }
Teletext Destination Settings
type TeletextSourceSettings ¶
type TeletextSourceSettings struct { // Optionally defines a region where TTML style captions will be displayed OutputRectangle *CaptionRectangle // Specifies the teletext page number within the data stream from which to extract // captions. Range of 0x100 (256) to 0x8FF (2303). Unused for passthrough. Should // be specified as a hexadecimal string with no "0x" prefix. PageNumber *string }
Teletext Source Settings
type TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening ¶
type TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening string
const ( TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpeningAuto TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening = "AUTO" TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpeningDisabled TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening = "DISABLED" TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpeningEnabled TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening = "ENABLED" )
Enum values for TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening
func (TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening) Values() []TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening
Values returns all known values for TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type TemporalFilterSettings ¶
type TemporalFilterSettings struct { // If you enable this filter, the results are the following: // // * If the source // content is noisy (it contains excessive digital artifacts), the filter cleans up // the source. // // * If the source content is already clean, the filter tends to // decrease the bitrate, especially when the rate control mode is QVBR. PostFilterSharpening TemporalFilterPostFilterSharpening // Choose a filter strength. We recommend a strength of 1 or 2. A higher strength // might take out good information, resulting in an image that is overly soft. Strength TemporalFilterStrength }
Temporal Filter Settings
type TemporalFilterStrength ¶
type TemporalFilterStrength string
const ( TemporalFilterStrengthAuto TemporalFilterStrength = "AUTO" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength1 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_1" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength2 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_2" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength3 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_3" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength4 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_4" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength5 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_5" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength6 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_6" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength7 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_7" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength8 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_8" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength9 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_9" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength10 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_10" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength11 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_11" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength12 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_12" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength13 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_13" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength14 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_14" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength15 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_15" TemporalFilterStrengthStrength16 TemporalFilterStrength = "STRENGTH_16" )
Enum values for TemporalFilterStrength
func (TemporalFilterStrength) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (TemporalFilterStrength) Values() []TemporalFilterStrength
Values returns all known values for TemporalFilterStrength. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type TimecodeConfig ¶
type TimecodeConfig struct { // Identifies the source for the timecode that will be associated with the events // outputs. -Embedded (embedded): Initialize the output timecode with timecode from // the the source. If no embedded timecode is detected in the source, the system // falls back to using "Start at 0" (zerobased). -System Clock (systemclock): Use // the UTC time. -Start at 0 (zerobased): The time of the first frame of the event // will be 00:00:00:00. // // This member is required. Source TimecodeConfigSource // Threshold in frames beyond which output timecode is resynchronized to the input // timecode. Discrepancies below this threshold are permitted to avoid unnecessary // discontinuities in the output timecode. No timecode sync when this is not // specified. SyncThreshold int32 }
Timecode Config
type TimecodeConfigSource ¶
type TimecodeConfigSource string
const ( TimecodeConfigSourceEmbedded TimecodeConfigSource = "EMBEDDED" TimecodeConfigSourceSystemclock TimecodeConfigSource = "SYSTEMCLOCK" TimecodeConfigSourceZerobased TimecodeConfigSource = "ZEROBASED" )
Enum values for TimecodeConfigSource
func (TimecodeConfigSource) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (TimecodeConfigSource) Values() []TimecodeConfigSource
Values returns all known values for TimecodeConfigSource. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type TooManyRequestsException ¶
type TooManyRequestsException struct {
Message *string
}
Placeholder documentation for TooManyRequestsException
func (*TooManyRequestsException) Error ¶
func (e *TooManyRequestsException) Error() string
func (*TooManyRequestsException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *TooManyRequestsException) ErrorCode() string
func (*TooManyRequestsException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *TooManyRequestsException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*TooManyRequestsException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *TooManyRequestsException) ErrorMessage() string
type TransferringInputDeviceSummary ¶ added in v0.29.0
type TransferringInputDeviceSummary struct { // The unique ID of the input device. Id *string // The optional message that the sender has attached to the transfer. Message *string // The AWS account ID for the recipient of the input device transfer. TargetCustomerId *string // The type (direction) of the input device transfer. TransferType InputDeviceTransferType }
Details about the input device that is being transferred.
type TtmlDestinationSettings ¶
type TtmlDestinationSettings struct { // When set to passthrough, passes through style and position information from a // TTML-like input source (TTML, SMPTE-TT, CFF-TT) to the CFF-TT output or TTML // output. StyleControl TtmlDestinationStyleControl }
Ttml Destination Settings
type TtmlDestinationStyleControl ¶
type TtmlDestinationStyleControl string
const ( TtmlDestinationStyleControlPassthrough TtmlDestinationStyleControl = "PASSTHROUGH" TtmlDestinationStyleControlUseConfigured TtmlDestinationStyleControl = "USE_CONFIGURED" )
Enum values for TtmlDestinationStyleControl
func (TtmlDestinationStyleControl) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (TtmlDestinationStyleControl) Values() []TtmlDestinationStyleControl
Values returns all known values for TtmlDestinationStyleControl. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type UdpContainerSettings ¶
type UdpContainerSettings struct { // M2ts Settings M2tsSettings *M2tsSettings }
Udp Container Settings
type UdpGroupSettings ¶
type UdpGroupSettings struct { // Specifies behavior of last resort when input video is lost, and no more backup // inputs are available. When dropTs is selected the entire transport stream will // stop being emitted. When dropProgram is selected the program can be dropped from // the transport stream (and replaced with null packets to meet the TS bitrate // requirement). Or, when emitProgram is chosen the transport stream will continue // to be produced normally with repeat frames, black frames, or slate frames // substituted for the absent input video. InputLossAction InputLossActionForUdpOut // Indicates ID3 frame that has the timecode. TimedMetadataId3Frame UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame // Timed Metadata interval in seconds. TimedMetadataId3Period int32 }
Udp Group Settings
type UdpOutputSettings ¶
type UdpOutputSettings struct { // Udp Container Settings // // This member is required. ContainerSettings *UdpContainerSettings // Destination address and port number for RTP or UDP packets. Can be unicast or // multicast RTP or UDP (eg. rtp://239.10.10.10:5001 or udp://10.100.100.100:5002). // // This member is required. Destination *OutputLocationRef // UDP output buffering in milliseconds. Larger values increase latency through the // transcoder but simultaneously assist the transcoder in maintaining a constant, // low-jitter UDP/RTP output while accommodating clock recovery, input switching, // input disruptions, picture reordering, etc. BufferMsec int32 // Settings for enabling and adjusting Forward Error Correction on UDP outputs. FecOutputSettings *FecOutputSettings }
Udp Output Settings
type UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame ¶
type UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame string
const ( UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameNone UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame = "NONE" UdpTimedMetadataId3FramePriv UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame = "PRIV" UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame = "TDRL" )
Enum values for UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame
func (UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame) Values() []UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame
Values returns all known values for UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type UnprocessableEntityException ¶
type UnprocessableEntityException struct { Message *string ValidationErrors []ValidationError }
Placeholder documentation for UnprocessableEntityException
func (*UnprocessableEntityException) Error ¶
func (e *UnprocessableEntityException) Error() string
func (*UnprocessableEntityException) ErrorCode ¶
func (e *UnprocessableEntityException) ErrorCode() string
func (*UnprocessableEntityException) ErrorFault ¶
func (e *UnprocessableEntityException) ErrorFault() smithy.ErrorFault
func (*UnprocessableEntityException) ErrorMessage ¶
func (e *UnprocessableEntityException) ErrorMessage() string
type ValidationError ¶
type ValidationError struct { // Path to the source of the error. ElementPath *string // The error message. ErrorMessage *string }
Placeholder documentation for ValidationError
type VideoBlackFailoverSettings ¶ added in v0.31.0
type VideoBlackFailoverSettings struct { // A value used in calculating the threshold below which MediaLive considers a // pixel to be 'black'. For the input to be considered black, every pixel in a // frame must be below this threshold. The threshold is calculated as a percentage // (expressed as a decimal) of white. Therefore .1 means 10% white (or 90% black). // Note how the formula works for any color depth. For example, if you set this // field to 0.1 in 10-bit color depth: (10230.1=102.3), which means a pixel value // of 102 or less is 'black'. If you set this field to .1 in an 8-bit color depth: // (2550.1=25.5), which means a pixel value of 25 or less is 'black'. The range is // 0.0 to 1.0, with any number of decimal places. BlackDetectThreshold float64 // The amount of time (in milliseconds) that the active input must be black before // automatic input failover occurs. VideoBlackThresholdMsec int32 }
Placeholder documentation for VideoBlackFailoverSettings
type VideoCodecSettings ¶
type VideoCodecSettings struct { // Frame Capture Settings FrameCaptureSettings *FrameCaptureSettings // H264 Settings H264Settings *H264Settings // H265 Settings H265Settings *H265Settings // Mpeg2 Settings Mpeg2Settings *Mpeg2Settings }
Video Codec Settings
type VideoDescription ¶
type VideoDescription struct { // The name of this VideoDescription. Outputs will use this name to uniquely // identify this Description. Description names should be unique within this Live // Event. // // This member is required. Name *string // Video codec settings. CodecSettings *VideoCodecSettings // Output video height, in pixels. Must be an even number. For most codecs, you can // leave this field and width blank in order to use the height and width // (resolution) from the source. Note, however, that leaving blank is not // recommended. For the Frame Capture codec, height and width are required. Height int32 // Indicates how MediaLive will respond to the AFD values that might be in the // input video. If you do not know what AFD signaling is, or if your downstream // system has not given you guidance, choose PASSTHROUGH. RESPOND: MediaLive clips // the input video using a formula that uses the AFD values (configured in // afdSignaling ), the input display aspect ratio, and the output display aspect // ratio. MediaLive also includes the AFD values in the output, unless the codec // for this encode is FRAME_CAPTURE. PASSTHROUGH: MediaLive ignores the AFD values // and does not clip the video. But MediaLive does include the values in the // output. NONE: MediaLive does not clip the input video and does not include the // AFD values in the output RespondToAfd VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd // STRETCH_TO_OUTPUT configures the output position to stretch the video to the // specified output resolution (height and width). This option will override any // position value. DEFAULT may insert black boxes (pillar boxes or letter boxes) // around the video to provide the specified output resolution. ScalingBehavior VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior // Changes the strength of the anti-alias filter used for scaling. 0 is the softest // setting, 100 is the sharpest. A setting of 50 is recommended for most content. Sharpness int32 // Output video width, in pixels. Must be an even number. For most codecs, you can // leave this field and height blank in order to use the height and width // (resolution) from the source. Note, however, that leaving blank is not // recommended. For the Frame Capture codec, height and width are required. Width int32 }
Video settings for this stream.
type VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd ¶
type VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd string
const ( VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdNone VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd = "NONE" VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdPassthrough VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd = "PASSTHROUGH" VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdRespond VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd = "RESPOND" )
Enum values for VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd
func (VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd) Values() []VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd
Values returns all known values for VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior ¶
type VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior string
const ( VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorDefault VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior = "DEFAULT" VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorStretchToOutput VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior = "STRETCH_TO_OUTPUT" )
Enum values for VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior
func (VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior) Values() []VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior
Values returns all known values for VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type VideoSelector ¶
type VideoSelector struct { // Specifies the color space of an input. This setting works in tandem with // colorSpaceUsage and a video description's colorSpaceSettingsChoice to determine // if any conversion will be performed. ColorSpace VideoSelectorColorSpace // Color space settings ColorSpaceSettings *VideoSelectorColorSpaceSettings // Applies only if colorSpace is a value other than follow. This field controls how // the value in the colorSpace field will be used. fallback means that when the // input does include color space data, that data will be used, but when the input // has no color space data, the value in colorSpace will be used. Choose fallback // if your input is sometimes missing color space data, but when it does have color // space data, that data is correct. force means to always use the value in // colorSpace. Choose force if your input usually has no color space data or might // have unreliable color space data. ColorSpaceUsage VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage // The video selector settings. SelectorSettings *VideoSelectorSettings }
Specifies a particular video stream within an input source. An input may have only a single video selector.
type VideoSelectorColorSpace ¶
type VideoSelectorColorSpace string
const ( VideoSelectorColorSpaceFollow VideoSelectorColorSpace = "FOLLOW" VideoSelectorColorSpaceHdr10 VideoSelectorColorSpace = "HDR10" VideoSelectorColorSpaceHlg2020 VideoSelectorColorSpace = "HLG_2020" VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec601 VideoSelectorColorSpace = "REC_601" VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec709 VideoSelectorColorSpace = "REC_709" )
Enum values for VideoSelectorColorSpace
func (VideoSelectorColorSpace) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (VideoSelectorColorSpace) Values() []VideoSelectorColorSpace
Values returns all known values for VideoSelectorColorSpace. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type VideoSelectorColorSpaceSettings ¶ added in v1.3.0
type VideoSelectorColorSpaceSettings struct { // Hdr10 Settings Hdr10Settings *Hdr10Settings }
Video Selector Color Space Settings
type VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage ¶
type VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage string
const ( VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageFallback VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage = "FALLBACK" VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageForce VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage = "FORCE" )
Enum values for VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage
func (VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage) Values() []VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage
Values returns all known values for VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type VideoSelectorPid ¶
type VideoSelectorPid struct { // Selects a specific PID from within a video source. Pid int32 }
Video Selector Pid
type VideoSelectorProgramId ¶
type VideoSelectorProgramId struct { // Selects a specific program from within a multi-program transport stream. If the // program doesn't exist, the first program within the transport stream will be // selected by default. ProgramId int32 }
Video Selector Program Id
type VideoSelectorSettings ¶
type VideoSelectorSettings struct { // Video Selector Pid VideoSelectorPid *VideoSelectorPid // Video Selector Program Id VideoSelectorProgramId *VideoSelectorProgramId }
Video Selector Settings
type VpcOutputSettings ¶ added in v1.2.0
type VpcOutputSettings struct { // A list of VPC subnet IDs from the same VPC. If STANDARD channel, subnet IDs must // be mapped to two unique availability zones (AZ). // // This member is required. SubnetIds []string // List of public address allocation ids to associate with ENIs that will be // created in Output VPC. Must specify one for SINGLE_PIPELINE, two for STANDARD // channels PublicAddressAllocationIds []string // A list of up to 5 EC2 VPC security group IDs to attach to the Output VPC network // interfaces. If none are specified then the VPC default security group will be // used SecurityGroupIds []string }
The properties for a private VPC Output When this property is specified, the output egress addresses will be created in a user specified VPC
type VpcOutputSettingsDescription ¶ added in v1.4.0
type VpcOutputSettingsDescription struct { // The Availability Zones where the vpc subnets are located. The first Availability // Zone applies to the first subnet in the list of subnets. The second Availability // Zone applies to the second subnet. AvailabilityZones []string // A list of Elastic Network Interfaces created by MediaLive in the customer's VPC NetworkInterfaceIds []string // A list of up EC2 VPC security group IDs attached to the Output VPC network // interfaces. SecurityGroupIds []string // A list of VPC subnet IDs from the same VPC. If STANDARD channel, subnet IDs must // be mapped to two unique availability zones (AZ). SubnetIds []string }
The properties for a private VPC Output
type WavCodingMode ¶ added in v0.29.0
type WavCodingMode string
const ( WavCodingModeCodingMode10 WavCodingMode = "CODING_MODE_1_0" WavCodingModeCodingMode20 WavCodingMode = "CODING_MODE_2_0" WavCodingModeCodingMode40 WavCodingMode = "CODING_MODE_4_0" WavCodingModeCodingMode80 WavCodingMode = "CODING_MODE_8_0" )
Enum values for WavCodingMode
func (WavCodingMode) Values ¶ added in v0.29.0
func (WavCodingMode) Values() []WavCodingMode
Values returns all known values for WavCodingMode. Note that this can be expanded in the future, and so it is only as up to date as the client. The ordering of this slice is not guaranteed to be stable across updates.
type WavSettings ¶ added in v0.29.0
type WavSettings struct { // Bits per sample. BitDepth float64 // The audio coding mode for the WAV audio. The mode determines the number of // channels in the audio. CodingMode WavCodingMode // Sample rate in Hz. SampleRate float64 }
Wav Settings
type WebvttDestinationSettings ¶
type WebvttDestinationSettings struct { }
Webvtt Destination Settings